blob: 6cda71b8a3da39f8712baa9336da804dab328086 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000039#include "llvm/LLVMContext.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000040#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000041#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000042#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +000043#include "llvm/Operator.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000044#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner9dbb4292009-11-09 23:28:39 +000045#include "llvm/Analysis/InstructionSimplify.h"
Victor Hernandezf006b182009-10-27 20:05:49 +000046#include "llvm/Analysis/MemoryBuiltins.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000047#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000048#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
49#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
50#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000051#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000052#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000053#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Torok Edwin7d696d82009-07-11 13:10:19 +000054#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000055#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000056#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000057#include "llvm/Support/IRBuilder.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000058#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000059#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000060#include "llvm/Support/TargetFolder.h"
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000061#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000062#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000063#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000064#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000065#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000066#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000067#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000068#include <climits>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000069using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000070using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
73STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
74STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
75STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
76STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000077
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +000078/// SelectPatternFlavor - We can match a variety of different patterns for
79/// select operations.
80enum SelectPatternFlavor {
81 SPF_UNKNOWN = 0,
82 SPF_SMIN, SPF_UMIN,
83 SPF_SMAX, SPF_UMAX
84 //SPF_ABS - TODO.
85};
86
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000087namespace {
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000088 /// InstCombineWorklist - This is the worklist management logic for
89 /// InstCombine.
90 class InstCombineWorklist {
91 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
92 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
93
94 void operator=(const InstCombineWorklist&RHS); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
95 InstCombineWorklist(const InstCombineWorklist&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
96 public:
97 InstCombineWorklist() {}
98
99 bool isEmpty() const { return Worklist.empty(); }
100
101 /// Add - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it isn't already
102 /// in it.
103 void Add(Instruction *I) {
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +0000104 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second) {
105 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ADD: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000106 Worklist.push_back(I);
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +0000107 }
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000108 }
109
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +0000110 void AddValue(Value *V) {
111 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
112 Add(I);
113 }
114
Chris Lattner67f7d542009-10-12 03:58:40 +0000115 /// AddInitialGroup - Add the specified batch of stuff in reverse order.
116 /// which should only be done when the worklist is empty and when the group
117 /// has no duplicates.
118 void AddInitialGroup(Instruction *const *List, unsigned NumEntries) {
119 assert(Worklist.empty() && "Worklist must be empty to add initial group");
120 Worklist.reserve(NumEntries+16);
121 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ADDING: " << NumEntries << " instrs to worklist\n");
122 for (; NumEntries; --NumEntries) {
123 Instruction *I = List[NumEntries-1];
124 WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size()));
125 Worklist.push_back(I);
126 }
127 }
128
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000129 // Remove - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000130 void Remove(Instruction *I) {
131 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
132 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
133
134 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
135 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
136
137 WorklistMap.erase(It);
138 }
139
140 Instruction *RemoveOne() {
141 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
142 Worklist.pop_back();
143 WorklistMap.erase(I);
144 return I;
145 }
146
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +0000147 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
148 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
149 /// now.
150 ///
151 void AddUsersToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
152 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
153 UI != UE; ++UI)
154 Add(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
155 }
156
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000157
158 /// Zap - check that the worklist is empty and nuke the backing store for
159 /// the map if it is large.
160 void Zap() {
161 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
162
163 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
164 WorklistMap.clear();
165 }
166 };
167} // end anonymous namespace.
168
169
170namespace {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000171 /// InstCombineIRInserter - This is an IRBuilder insertion helper that works
172 /// just like the normal insertion helper, but also adds any new instructions
173 /// to the instcombine worklist.
174 class InstCombineIRInserter : public IRBuilderDefaultInserter<true> {
175 InstCombineWorklist &Worklist;
176 public:
177 InstCombineIRInserter(InstCombineWorklist &WL) : Worklist(WL) {}
178
179 void InsertHelper(Instruction *I, const Twine &Name,
180 BasicBlock *BB, BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt) const {
181 IRBuilderDefaultInserter<true>::InsertHelper(I, Name, BB, InsertPt);
182 Worklist.Add(I);
183 }
184 };
185} // end anonymous namespace
186
187
188namespace {
Chris Lattner3e8b6632009-09-02 06:11:42 +0000189 class InstCombiner : public FunctionPass,
190 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000191 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +0000192 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +0000193 bool MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000194 public:
Chris Lattner75551f72009-08-30 17:53:59 +0000195 /// Worklist - All of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000196 InstCombineWorklist Worklist;
197
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000198 /// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
199 /// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +0000200 typedef IRBuilder<true, TargetFolder, InstCombineIRInserter> BuilderTy;
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +0000201 BuilderTy *Builder;
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000202
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +0000203 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000204 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID), TD(0), Builder(0) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +0000205
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +0000206 LLVMContext *Context;
207 LLVMContext *getContext() const { return Context; }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000208
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000209 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000210 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000211
212 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000213
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000214 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000215 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000216 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000217 }
218
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000219 TargetData *getTargetData() const { return TD; }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000220
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000221 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
222 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
223 // Return Value:
224 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000225 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000226 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000227 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000228 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000229 Instruction *visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +0000230 Value *OptimizePointerDifference(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, const Type *Ty);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000231 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000232 Instruction *visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000233 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000234 Instruction *visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000235 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
236 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
237 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000238 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000239 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
240 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000241 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
242 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
243 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
244 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
245 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000246 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +0000247 Instruction *FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000248 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +0000249 Instruction *FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +0000250 Instruction *FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +0000251 Instruction *FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +0000252 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000253 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
254 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000255 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
256 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
257 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
258 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000259 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
260 Constant *RHSC);
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +0000261 Instruction *FoldCmpLoadFromIndexedGlobal(GetElementPtrInst *GEP,
262 GlobalVariable *GV, CmpInst &ICI);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000263 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
264 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
265 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000266 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
267 Instruction *LHS,
268 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000269 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
270 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +0000271 Instruction *FoldICmpAddOpCst(ICmpInst &ICI, Value *X, ConstantInt *CI,
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +0000272 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, Value *TheAdd);
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +0000273 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(GEPOperator *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000274 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000275 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000276 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000277 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
278 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000279 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000280 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
281 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
282 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000283 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000284 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000285 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
286 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000287 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
288 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000289 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000290 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000291 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000292 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
293 Instruction *FI);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +0000294 Instruction *FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value*, Value*);
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +0000295 Instruction *FoldSPFofSPF(Instruction *Inner, SelectPatternFlavor SPF1,
296 Value *A, Value *B, Instruction &Outer,
297 SelectPatternFlavor SPF2, Value *C);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000298 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
299 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000300 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
301 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +0000302
303 Instruction *SliceUpIllegalIntegerPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000304 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
305 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +0000306 Instruction *visitAllocaInst(AllocaInst &AI);
Victor Hernandez66284e02009-10-24 04:23:03 +0000307 Instruction *visitFree(Instruction &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000308 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000309 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000310 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000311 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000312 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000313 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000314 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000315 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000316
317 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000318 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000319
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000320 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000321 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000322 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000323 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000324 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
325 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000326 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +0000327 DbgDeclareInst *hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V);
328
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000329
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000330 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000331 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
332 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
333 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000334 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000335 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
336 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000337 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
338 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000339 Worklist.Add(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000340 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000341 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000342
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000343 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
344 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
345 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
346 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
347 // modified.
348 //
349 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +0000350 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000351
352 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
353 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
354 if (&I == V)
355 V = UndefValue::get(I.getType());
356
357 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
358 return &I;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000359 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000360
361 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
362 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
363 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
364 // this function.
365 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +0000366 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ERASE " << I << '\n');
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +0000367
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000368 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000369 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
370 // use counts.
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +0000371 if (I.getNumOperands() < 8) {
372 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
373 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
374 Worklist.Add(Op);
375 }
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000376 Worklist.Remove(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000377 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +0000378 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000379 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
380 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000381
382 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
383 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
384 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
385 }
386
387 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
388 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
389 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
390 }
391 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
392 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
393 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000394
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000395 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000396
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000397 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
398 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000399 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000400
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000401 /// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value
402 /// based on the demanded bits.
403 Value *SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
404 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
405 unsigned Depth);
406 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000407 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000408 unsigned Depth=0);
409
410 /// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
411 /// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
412 /// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
413 bool SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst);
414
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +0000415 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
416 APInt& UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000417
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +0000418 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select
419 // which has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction
420 // into the PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are
421 // constants).
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +0000422 //
423 // If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
424 // that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
425 // threading.
426 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I, bool AllowAggressive = false);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000427
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000428 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
429 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
430 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
431 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000432 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +0000433 Instruction *FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner751a3622009-11-01 20:04:24 +0000434 Instruction *FoldPHIArgLoadIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +0000435
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000436
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000437 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
438 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000439
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000440 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000441 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000442 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000443 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +0000444 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocaInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000445 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000446 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000447 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000448 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000449
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000450
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000451 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000452
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000453 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +0000454 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000455 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
456 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000457
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000458 };
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000459} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000460
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000461char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
462static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
463X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
464
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000465// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000466// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000467static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000468 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000469 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) ||
470 BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V) ||
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000471 BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000472 return 3;
473 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000474 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000475 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
476 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000477}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000478
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000479// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
480// it.
481static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000482 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000483}
484
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000485// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
486// though a va_arg area...
487static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000488 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
489 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000490 return Type::getInt32Ty(Ty->getContext());
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000491 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000492 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000493}
494
Chris Lattnerc22d4d12009-11-10 07:23:37 +0000495/// ShouldChangeType - Return true if it is desirable to convert a computation
496/// from 'From' to 'To'. We don't want to convert from a legal to an illegal
497/// type for example, or from a smaller to a larger illegal type.
498static bool ShouldChangeType(const Type *From, const Type *To,
499 const TargetData *TD) {
500 assert(isa<IntegerType>(From) && isa<IntegerType>(To));
501
502 // If we don't have TD, we don't know if the source/dest are legal.
503 if (!TD) return false;
504
505 unsigned FromWidth = From->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
506 unsigned ToWidth = To->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
507 bool FromLegal = TD->isLegalInteger(FromWidth);
508 bool ToLegal = TD->isLegalInteger(ToWidth);
509
510 // If this is a legal integer from type, and the result would be an illegal
511 // type, don't do the transformation.
512 if (FromLegal && !ToLegal)
513 return false;
514
515 // Otherwise, if both are illegal, do not increase the size of the result. We
516 // do allow things like i160 -> i64, but not i64 -> i160.
517 if (!FromLegal && !ToLegal && ToWidth > FromWidth)
518 return false;
519
520 return true;
521}
522
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000523/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
524/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
525/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000526static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
Dan Gohman016de812009-07-17 23:55:56 +0000527 if (Operator *O = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
528 if (O->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
529 return O->getOperand(0);
530 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(V))
531 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
532 return GEP->getPointerOperand();
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000533 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000534 return 0;
535}
536
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000537/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
538/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000539static Instruction::CastOps
540isEliminableCastPair(
541 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
542 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
543 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
544 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
545) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000546
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000547 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
548 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000549
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000550 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
551 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
552 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000553
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000554 unsigned Res = CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000555 DstTy,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000556 TD ? TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()) : 0);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000557
558 // We don't want to form an inttoptr or ptrtoint that converts to an integer
559 // type that differs from the pointer size.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000560 if ((Res == Instruction::IntToPtr &&
Dan Gohman5e9bb732009-08-19 23:38:22 +0000561 (!TD || SrcTy != TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()))) ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000562 (Res == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
Dan Gohman5e9bb732009-08-19 23:38:22 +0000563 (!TD || DstTy != TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()))))
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000564 Res = 0;
565
566 return Instruction::CastOps(Res);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000567}
568
569/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
570/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
571/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000572static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
573 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000574 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
575
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000576 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000577 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000578 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000579 return false;
580 return true;
581}
582
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000583// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
584// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000585//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000586// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
587// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
588// binary operators.
589//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000590// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
591// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000592//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000593bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000594 bool Changed = false;
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000595 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000596 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000597
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000598 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
599 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000600 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
601 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
602 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000603 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000604 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
605 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000606 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
607 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
608 return true;
609 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
610 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
611 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
612 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
613 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
614
615 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000616 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000617 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000618 Op1->getOperand(0),
619 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000620 Worklist.Add(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000621 I.setOperand(0, New);
622 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
623 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000624 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000625 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000626 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000627}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000628
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000629// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
630// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000631//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000632static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000633 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000634 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000635
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000636 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
637 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000638 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000639
640 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
641 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000642 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000643
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000644 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000645}
646
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000647// dyn_castFNegVal - Given a 'fsub' instruction, return the RHS of the
648// instruction if the LHS is a constant negative zero (which is the 'negate'
649// form).
650//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000651static inline Value *dyn_castFNegVal(Value *V) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000652 if (BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000653 return BinaryOperator::getFNegArgument(V);
654
655 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
656 if (ConstantFP *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000657 return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000658
659 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
660 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isFloatingPoint())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000661 return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000662
663 return 0;
664}
665
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +0000666/// MatchSelectPattern - Pattern match integer [SU]MIN, [SU]MAX, and ABS idioms,
667/// returning the kind and providing the out parameter results if we
668/// successfully match.
669static SelectPatternFlavor
670MatchSelectPattern(Value *V, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS) {
671 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V);
672 if (SI == 0) return SPF_UNKNOWN;
673
674 ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI->getCondition());
675 if (ICI == 0) return SPF_UNKNOWN;
676
677 LHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
678 RHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
679
680 // (icmp X, Y) ? X : Y
681 if (SI->getTrueValue() == ICI->getOperand(0) &&
682 SI->getFalseValue() == ICI->getOperand(1)) {
683 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
684 default: return SPF_UNKNOWN; // Equality.
685 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
686 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return SPF_UMAX;
687 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
688 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return SPF_SMAX;
689 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
690 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return SPF_UMIN;
691 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
692 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return SPF_SMIN;
693 }
694 }
695
696 // (icmp X, Y) ? Y : X
697 if (SI->getTrueValue() == ICI->getOperand(1) &&
698 SI->getFalseValue() == ICI->getOperand(0)) {
699 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
700 default: return SPF_UNKNOWN; // Equality.
701 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
702 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return SPF_UMIN;
703 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return SPF_SMIN;
705 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
706 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return SPF_UMAX;
707 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return SPF_SMAX;
709 }
710 }
711
712 // TODO: (X > 4) ? X : 5 --> (X >= 5) ? X : 5 --> MAX(X, 5)
713
714 return SPF_UNKNOWN;
715}
716
Chris Lattner48b59ec2009-10-26 15:40:07 +0000717/// isFreeToInvert - Return true if the specified value is free to invert (apply
718/// ~ to). This happens in cases where the ~ can be eliminated.
719static inline bool isFreeToInvert(Value *V) {
720 // ~(~(X)) -> X.
Evan Cheng85def162009-10-26 03:51:32 +0000721 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattner48b59ec2009-10-26 15:40:07 +0000722 return true;
723
724 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values.
725 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
726 return true;
727
728 // Compares can be inverted if they have a single use.
729 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(V))
730 return CI->hasOneUse();
731
732 return false;
733}
734
735static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
736 // If this is not(not(x)) don't return that this is a not: we want the two
737 // not's to be folded first.
738 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V)) {
739 Value *Operand = BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
740 if (!isFreeToInvert(Operand))
741 return Operand;
742 }
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000743
744 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000745 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000746 return ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), ~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000747 return 0;
748}
749
Chris Lattner48b59ec2009-10-26 15:40:07 +0000750
751
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000752// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
753// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000754// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
755// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000756//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000757static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000758 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000759 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000760 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000761 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000762 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000763 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000764 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000765 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000766 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000767 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000768 CST = ConstantInt::get(V->getType()->getContext(),
769 APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000770 return I->getOperand(0);
771 }
772 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000773 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000774}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000775
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000776/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000777static Constant *AddOne(Constant *C) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000778 return ConstantExpr::getAdd(C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +0000779 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000780}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000781/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000782static Constant *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000783 return ConstantExpr::getSub(C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +0000784 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000785}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000786/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
787/// this size.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000788static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000789 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
790 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
791 if (sign) {
792 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
793 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
794 } else {
795 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
796 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
797 }
798
799 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
800
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +0000801 if (!sign)
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000802 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +0000803
804 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
805 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
806 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000807}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000808
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000809
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000810/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
811/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
812/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
813/// constant and return true.
814static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000815 APInt Demanded) {
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000816 assert(I && "No instruction?");
817 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
818
819 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
820 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
821 if (!OpC) return false;
822
823 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
824 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
825 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
826 return false;
827
828 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
829 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000830 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(OpC->getType(), Demanded));
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000831 return true;
832}
833
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000834// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
835// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
836// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
837// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000838static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000839 const APInt& KnownOne,
840 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000841 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
842 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
843 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
844 "KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000845 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000846
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000847 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
848 // bit if it is unknown.
849 Min = KnownOne;
850 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
851
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000852 if (UnknownBits.isNegative()) { // Sign bit is unknown
853 Min.set(Min.getBitWidth()-1);
854 Max.clear(Max.getBitWidth()-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000855 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000856}
857
858// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
859// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
860// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
861// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000862static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt &KnownZero,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000863 const APInt &KnownOne,
864 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000865 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
866 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
867 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000868 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000869 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000870
871 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
872 Min = KnownOne;
873 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
874 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
875}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000876
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000877/// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
878/// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
879/// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
880bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000881 unsigned BitWidth = Inst.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000882 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
883 APInt DemandedMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
884
885 Value *V = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(&Inst, DemandedMask,
886 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0);
887 if (V == 0) return false;
888 if (V == &Inst) return true;
889 ReplaceInstUsesWith(Inst, V);
890 return true;
891}
892
893/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This form of SimplifyDemandedBits simplifies the
894/// specified instruction operand if possible, updating it in place. It returns
895/// true if it made any change and false otherwise.
896bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
897 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
898 unsigned Depth) {
899 Value *NewVal = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(U.get(), DemandedMask,
900 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
901 if (NewVal == 0) return false;
Dan Gohmane41a1152009-10-05 16:31:55 +0000902 U = NewVal;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000903 return true;
904}
905
906
907/// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
908/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000909/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
910/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
911/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
912/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
913/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000914/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000915/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
916/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
917/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
918/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
919/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
920/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
921/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000922///
923/// This returns null if it did not change anything and it permits no
924/// simplification. This returns V itself if it did some simplification of V's
925/// operands based on the information about what bits are demanded. This returns
926/// some other non-null value if it found out that V is equal to another value
927/// in the context where the specified bits are demanded, but not for all users.
928Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
929 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
930 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000931 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
932 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
933 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000934 const Type *VTy = V->getType();
935 assert((TD || !isa<PointerType>(VTy)) &&
936 "SimplifyDemandedBits needs to know bit widths!");
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000937 assert((!TD || TD->getTypeSizeInBits(VTy->getScalarType()) == BitWidth) &&
938 (!VTy->isIntOrIntVector() ||
939 VTy->getScalarSizeInBits() == BitWidth) &&
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000940 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000941 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000942 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne "
943 "must have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000944 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
945 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
946 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
947 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000948 return 0;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000949 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000950 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(V)) {
951 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
952 KnownOne.clear();
953 KnownZero = DemandedMask;
954 return 0;
955 }
956
Chris Lattner08d2cc72009-01-31 07:26:06 +0000957 KnownZero.clear();
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000958 KnownOne.clear();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000959 if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
960 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
961 return 0;
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +0000962 return UndefValue::get(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000963 }
964
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000965 if (Depth == 6) // Limit search depth.
966 return 0;
967
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000968 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
969 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
970
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000971 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
972 if (!I) {
973 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
974 return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
975 }
976
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000977 // If there are multiple uses of this value and we aren't at the root, then
978 // we can't do any simplifications of the operands, because DemandedMask
979 // only reflects the bits demanded by *one* of the users.
980 if (Depth != 0 && !I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000981 // Despite the fact that we can't simplify this instruction in all User's
982 // context, we can at least compute the knownzero/knownone bits, and we can
983 // do simplifications that apply to *just* the one user if we know that
984 // this instruction has a simpler value in that context.
985 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
986 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
987 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
988 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
989 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
990 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
991
992 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
993 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and' in this
994 // context.
995 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
996 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
997 return I->getOperand(0);
998 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
999 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
1000 return I->getOperand(1);
1001
1002 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
1003 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001004 return Constant::getNullValue(VTy);
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +00001005
1006 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
1007 // We can simplify (X|Y) -> X or Y in the user's context if we know that
1008 // only bits from X or Y are demanded.
1009
1010 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
1011 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1012 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
1013 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
1014 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
1015
1016 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the
1017 // other. These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or' in this
1018 // context.
1019 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
1020 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
1021 return I->getOperand(0);
1022 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1023 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1024 return I->getOperand(1);
1025
1026 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1027 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1028 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1029 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1030 return I->getOperand(0);
1031 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1032 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1033 return I->getOperand(1);
1034 }
1035
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +00001036 // Compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
1037 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
1038 return 0;
1039 }
1040
1041 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
1042 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits so that we can try to simplify the
1043 // operands. This allows visitTruncInst (for example) to simplify the
1044 // operand of a trunc without duplicating all the logic below.
1045 if (Depth == 0 && !V->hasOneUse())
1046 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
1047
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001048 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001049 default:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001050 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001051 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001052 case Instruction::And:
1053 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001054 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
1055 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1056 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001057 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001058 return I;
1059 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1060 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001061
1062 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
1063 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
1064 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
1065 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001066 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001067 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
1068 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001069 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001070
1071 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
1072 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001073 return Constant::getNullValue(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001074
1075 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001076 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001077 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078
1079 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
1080 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1081 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
1082 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
1083 break;
1084 case Instruction::Or:
1085 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001086 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
1087 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1088 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001089 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001090 return I;
1091 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1092 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001093
1094 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1095 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
1096 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
1097 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001098 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001099 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1100 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001101 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001102
1103 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1104 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1105 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1106 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001107 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001108 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1109 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001110 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001111
1112 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001113 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001114 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001115
1116 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1117 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1118 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1119 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1120 break;
1121 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001122 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
1123 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1124 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001125 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001126 return I;
1127 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1128 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001129
1130 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1131 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1132 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001133 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001135 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001136
1137 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1138 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1139 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1140 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1141 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1142 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1143
1144 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1145 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1146 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattner95afdfe2009-08-31 04:36:22 +00001147 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1148 Instruction *Or =
1149 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1150 I->getName());
1151 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1152 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001153
1154 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1155 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1156 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1157 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1158 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1159 // all known
1160 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
Dan Gohman43ee5f72009-08-03 22:07:33 +00001161 Constant *AndC = Constant::getIntegerValue(VTy,
1162 ~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001163 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001164 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001165 return InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166 }
1167 }
1168
1169 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1170 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001171 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001172 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001173
Chris Lattnerd0883142009-10-11 22:22:13 +00001174 // If our LHS is an 'and' and if it has one use, and if any of the bits we
1175 // are flipping are known to be set, then the xor is just resetting those
1176 // bits to zero. We can just knock out bits from the 'and' and the 'xor',
1177 // simplifying both of them.
1178 if (Instruction *LHSInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I->getOperand(0)))
1179 if (LHSInst->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && LHSInst->hasOneUse() &&
1180 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)) &&
1181 isa<ConstantInt>(LHSInst->getOperand(1)) &&
1182 (LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask) != 0) {
1183 ConstantInt *AndRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSInst->getOperand(1));
1184 ConstantInt *XorRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
1185 APInt NewMask = ~(LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1186
1187 Constant *AndC =
1188 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), NewMask & AndRHS->getValue());
1189 Instruction *NewAnd =
1190 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1191 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, *I);
1192
1193 Constant *XorC =
1194 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), NewMask & XorRHS->getValue());
1195 Instruction *NewXor =
1196 BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, XorC, "tmp");
1197 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewXor, *I);
1198 }
1199
1200
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001201 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1202 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1203 break;
1204 }
1205 case Instruction::Select:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001206 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(2), DemandedMask,
1207 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1208 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001209 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001210 return I;
1211 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1212 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001213
1214 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001215 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask) ||
1216 ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001217 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218
1219 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1220 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1221 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1222 break;
1223 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001224 unsigned truncBf = I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001225 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1226 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1227 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001228 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001229 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001230 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001231 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1232 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1233 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001234 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001235 break;
1236 }
1237 case Instruction::BitCast:
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001238 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrIntVector())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001239 return false; // vector->int or fp->int?
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001240
1241 if (const VectorType *DstVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getType())) {
1242 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy =
1243 dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
1244 if (DstVTy->getNumElements() != SrcVTy->getNumElements())
1245 // Don't touch a bitcast between vectors of different element counts.
1246 return false;
1247 } else
1248 // Don't touch a scalar-to-vector bitcast.
1249 return false;
1250 } else if (isa<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType()))
1251 // Don't touch a vector-to-scalar bitcast.
1252 return false;
1253
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001254 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001255 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001256 return I;
1257 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001258 break;
1259 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1260 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001261 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001262
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001263 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1264 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1265 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001266 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001267 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001268 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001269 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1270 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1271 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001272 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001273 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001274 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001275 break;
1276 }
1277 case Instruction::SExt: {
1278 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001279 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001280
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001281 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001282 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001283
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001284 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001285 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1286 // bit is demanded.
1287 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001288 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001289
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001290 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1291 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1292 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001293 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InputDemandedBits,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001294 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001295 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001296 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1297 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1298 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001299 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001300
1301 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1302 // top bits of the result.
1303
1304 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1305 // convert this into a zero extension.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001306 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001307 // Convert to ZExt cast
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001308 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName());
1309 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *I);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001310 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001311 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001312 }
1313 break;
1314 }
1315 case Instruction::Add: {
1316 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1317 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1318 // either.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001319 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001320
1321 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1322 // we can do.
1323 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1324 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1325 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1326 if (RHS->isZero())
1327 break;
1328
1329 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1330 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001331 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001332
1333 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001334 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InDemandedBits,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001335 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001336 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001337
1338 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1339 // the constant.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001340 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001341 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001342
1343 // Avoid excess work.
1344 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1345 break;
1346
1347 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1348 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1349 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001350 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001351 I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001352 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001353 }
1354
1355 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1356 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1357 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1358 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1359 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1360
1361 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1362 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1363 // this scan.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001364 const APInt &RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001365 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001366
1367 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1368
1369 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1370 // other, and there is no input carry.
1371 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1372 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1373
1374 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1375 // is no input carry.
1376 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1377 } else {
1378 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1379 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001380 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001381 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1382 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001383 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001384 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1385 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1386 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001387 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001388 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001389 }
1390 }
1391 break;
1392 }
1393 case Instruction::Sub:
1394 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1395 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001396 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001397 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1398 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001399 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001400 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001401 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1402 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1403 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001404 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001405 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001406 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001407 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1408 // the known zeros and ones.
1409 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001410 break;
1411 case Instruction::Shl:
1412 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001413 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001414 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001415 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001416 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001417 return I;
1418 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001419 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1420 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1421 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001422 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001423 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001424 }
1425 break;
1426 case Instruction::LShr:
1427 // For a logical shift right
1428 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001429 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001430
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001431 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001432 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001433 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001434 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001435 return I;
1436 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001437 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1438 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001439 if (ShiftAmt) {
1440 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001441 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001442 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1443 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001444 }
1445 break;
1446 case Instruction::AShr:
1447 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1448 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1449 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1450 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1451 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1452 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001453 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001454 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001455 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001456 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001457
1458 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1459 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1460 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001461 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001462
1463 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001464 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001465
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001466 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001467 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001468 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1469 // demanded.
1470 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1471 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001472 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001473 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001474 return I;
1475 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001476 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001477 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001478 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1479 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1480
1481 // Handle the sign bits.
1482 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1483 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1484 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1485
1486 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1487 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001488 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001489 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1490 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001491 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001492 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001493 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001494 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1495 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1496 }
1497 }
1498 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001499 case Instruction::SRem:
1500 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001501 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1502 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Eli Friedmana999a512009-06-17 02:57:36 +00001503 if (DemandedMask.ult(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001504 return I->getOperand(0);
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001505
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001506 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001507 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001508 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), Mask2,
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001509 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001510 return I;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001511
1512 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1513 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001514
1515 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001516
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001517 assert(!(KnownZero & KnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001518 }
1519 }
1520 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001521 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001522 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1523 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001524 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), AllOnes,
1525 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1) ||
1526 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001527 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001528 return I;
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001529
Chris Lattner455e9ab2009-01-21 18:09:24 +00001530 unsigned Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001531 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1532 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1533 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001534 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001535 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001536 case Instruction::Call:
1537 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1538 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1539 default: break;
1540 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1541 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1542 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1543 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1544 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1545
1546 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1547 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1548 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1549 NLZ &= ~7;
1550 NTZ &= ~7;
1551 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1552 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1553 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1554 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1555
1556 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1557 // the right place.
1558 Instruction *NewVal;
1559 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1560 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001561 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001562 else
1563 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001564 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001565 NewVal->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001566 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001567 }
1568
1569 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1570 break;
1571 }
1572 }
1573 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001574 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001575 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001576 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001577
1578 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1579 // constant.
Dan Gohman43ee5f72009-08-03 22:07:33 +00001580 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1581 return Constant::getIntegerValue(VTy, RHSKnownOne);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001582 return false;
1583}
1584
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001585
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001586/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001587/// any number of elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001588/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1589/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1590///
1591/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1592/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1593/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001594Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
1595 APInt& UndefElts,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001596 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001597 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001598 APInt EltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001599 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001600
1601 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1602 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1603 UndefElts = EltMask;
1604 return 0;
1605 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1606 UndefElts = EltMask;
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001607 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001608 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001609
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001610 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001611 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1612 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001613 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001614
1615 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1616 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001617 if (!DemandedElts[i]) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001618 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001619 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001620 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1621 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001622 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001623 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1624 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1625 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001626
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001627 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001628 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001629 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1630 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001631 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001632 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001633
1634 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1635 // anything.
1636 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1637 return 0;
1638
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001639 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001640 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001641 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001642 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001643 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
1644 Constant *Elt = DemandedElts[i] ? Zero : Undef;
1645 Elts.push_back(Elt);
1646 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001647 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001648 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001649 }
1650
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001651 // Limit search depth.
1652 if (Depth == 10)
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001653 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001654
1655 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1656 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1657 // are needed.
1658 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1659 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1660 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1661 // the main instcombine process.
1662 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001663 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001664 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001665
1666 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1667 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001668 }
1669
1670 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001671 if (!I) return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001672
1673 bool MadeChange = false;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001674 APInt UndefElts2(VWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001675 Value *TmpV;
1676 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1677 default: break;
1678
1679 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1680 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1681 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001682 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001683 if (Idx == 0) {
1684 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1685 // which elt is getting updated.
1686 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1687 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1688 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1689 break;
1690 }
1691
1692 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1693 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001694 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc3a3e362009-08-30 06:20:05 +00001695 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || !DemandedElts[IdxNo]) {
1696 Worklist.Add(I);
1697 return I->getOperand(0);
1698 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001699
1700 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1701 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001702 APInt DemandedElts2 = DemandedElts;
1703 DemandedElts2.clear(IdxNo);
1704 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts2,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001705 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1706 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1707
1708 // The inserted element is defined.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001709 UndefElts.clear(IdxNo);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001710 break;
1711 }
1712 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1713 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001714 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1715 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001716 APInt LeftDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0), RightDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001717 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001718 if (DemandedElts[i]) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001719 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1720 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001721 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001722 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001723 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001724 LeftDemanded.set(MaskVal);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001725 else
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001726 RightDemanded.set(MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001727 }
1728 }
1729 }
1730
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001731 APInt UndefElts4(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001732 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001733 UndefElts4, Depth+1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001734 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1735
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001736 APInt UndefElts3(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001737 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1738 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1739 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1740
1741 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1742 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1743 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001744 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001745 UndefElts.set(i);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001746 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001747 if (UndefElts4[MaskVal]) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001748 NewUndefElts = true;
1749 UndefElts.set(i);
1750 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001751 } else {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001752 if (UndefElts3[MaskVal - LHSVWidth]) {
1753 NewUndefElts = true;
1754 UndefElts.set(i);
1755 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001756 }
1757 }
1758
1759 if (NewUndefElts) {
1760 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1761 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1762 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001763 if (UndefElts[i])
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001764 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001765 else
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001766 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context),
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001767 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1768 }
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001769 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001770 MadeChange = true;
1771 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001772 break;
1773 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001774 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001775 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001776 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1777 if (!VTy) break;
1778 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001779 APInt InputDemandedElts(InVWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001780 unsigned Ratio;
1781
1782 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001783 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001784 // elements as are demanded of us.
1785 Ratio = 1;
1786 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1787 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1788 // Untested so far.
1789 break;
1790
1791 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1792 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1793 // elements are live.
1794 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1795 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001796 if (DemandedElts[OutIdx])
1797 InputDemandedElts.set(OutIdx/Ratio);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001798 }
1799 } else {
1800 // Untested so far.
1801 break;
1802
1803 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1804 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1805 // live.
1806 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1807 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001808 if (DemandedElts[InIdx/Ratio])
1809 InputDemandedElts.set(InIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001810 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001811
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001812 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1813 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1814 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1815 if (TmpV) {
1816 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1817 MadeChange = true;
1818 }
1819
1820 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1821 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001822 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001823 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1824 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1825 // undef.
1826 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001827 if (UndefElts2[OutIdx/Ratio])
1828 UndefElts.set(OutIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001829 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001830 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001831 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1832 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1833 // elements are undef.
1834 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1835 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001836 if (!UndefElts2[InIdx]) // Not undef?
1837 UndefElts.clear(InIdx/Ratio); // Clear undef bit.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001838 }
1839 break;
1840 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001841 case Instruction::And:
1842 case Instruction::Or:
1843 case Instruction::Xor:
1844 case Instruction::Add:
1845 case Instruction::Sub:
1846 case Instruction::Mul:
1847 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1848 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1849 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1850 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1851 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1852 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1853 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1854
1855 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1856 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1857 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1858 break;
1859
1860 case Instruction::Call: {
1861 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1862 if (!II) break;
1863 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1864 default: break;
1865
1866 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1867 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1868 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1869 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1870 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1871 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1872 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1873 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1874 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1875 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1876 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1877 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1878 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1879 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1880 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1881 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1882
1883 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1884 // scalarize it now.
1885 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1886 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1887 default: break;
1888 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1889 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1890 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1891 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1892 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1893 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1894 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1895 // Extract the element as scalars.
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +00001896 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(ExtractElementInst::Create(LHS,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001897 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +00001898 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(ExtractElementInst::Create(RHS,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001899 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001900
1901 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001902 default: llvm_unreachable("Case stmts out of sync!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001903 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1904 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001905 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001906 II->getName()), *II);
1907 break;
1908 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1909 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001910 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001911 II->getName()), *II);
1912 break;
1913 }
1914
1915 Instruction *New =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001916 InsertElementInst::Create(
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001917 UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001918 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001919 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001920 return New;
1921 }
1922 }
1923
1924 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1925 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1926 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1927 break;
1928 }
1929 break;
1930 }
1931 }
1932 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1933}
1934
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001935
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001936/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1937/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1938/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1939/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1940/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1941/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1942/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1943///
1944template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001945static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001946 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1947 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1948
1949 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1950 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1951 return F.apply(Root);
1952
1953 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1954 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001955 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001956 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1957 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1958
1959 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1960 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1961 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1962 ShouldApply = true;
1963 }
1964
1965 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1966 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1967 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001968 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1969 // and perform the reassociation.
1970 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1971
1972 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1973 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1974
1975 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1976 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001977 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001978 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001979 return 0;
1980 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001981 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001982 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001983 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001984 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001985 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001986
1987 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1988 // get to LHSI.
1989 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1990 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001991 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1992 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001993 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001994 ARI = NextLHSI;
1995
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001996 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1997 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1998 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1999 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
2000 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002001
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002002 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
2003 // the transformation...
2004 return F.apply(Root);
2005 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002006
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002007 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
2008 }
2009 return 0;
2010}
2011
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00002012namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002013
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00002014// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002015struct AddRHS {
2016 Value *RHS;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002017 explicit AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002018 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
2019 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00002020 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002021 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002022 }
2023};
2024
2025// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
2026// iff C1&C2 == 0
2027struct AddMaskingAnd {
2028 Constant *C2;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002029 explicit AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002030 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002031 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002032 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002033 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002034 }
2035 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002036 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002037 }
2038};
2039
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00002040}
2041
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002042static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002043 InstCombiner *IC) {
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00002044 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I))
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00002045 return IC->Builder->CreateCast(CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType());
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002046
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002047 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002048 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
2049 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002050
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002051 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
2052 if (ConstIsRHS)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002053 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
2054 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002055 }
2056
2057 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
2058 if (!ConstIsRHS)
2059 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002060
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002061 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002062 return IC->Builder->CreateBinOp(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,
2063 SO->getName()+".op");
2064 if (ICmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(&I))
2065 return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
2066 SO->getName()+".cmp");
2067 if (FCmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(&I))
2068 return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
2069 SO->getName()+".cmp");
2070 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002071}
2072
2073// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
2074// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
2075// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
2076// not have a second operand.
2077static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
2078 InstCombiner *IC) {
2079 // Don't modify shared select instructions
2080 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
2081 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
2082 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
2083
2084 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00002085 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002086 if (SI->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*IC->getContext())) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00002087
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002088 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
2089 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
2090
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002091 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
2092 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002093 }
2094 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002095}
2096
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002097
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002098/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select which
2099/// has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the
2100/// PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00002101///
2102/// If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
2103/// that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
2104/// threading.
2105Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I,
2106 bool AllowAggressive) {
2107 AllowAggressive = false;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002108 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002109 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00002110 if (NumPHIValues == 0 ||
2111 // We normally only transform phis with a single use, unless we're trying
2112 // hard to make jump threading happen.
2113 (!PN->hasOneUse() && !AllowAggressive))
2114 return 0;
2115
2116
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002117 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are simple constants
2118 // (constantint/constantfp/undef). If there is one non-constant value,
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002119 // remember the BB it is in. If there is more than one or if *it* is a PHI,
2120 // bail out. We don't do arbitrary constant expressions here because moving
2121 // their computation can be expensive without a cost model.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002122 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
2123 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002124 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)) ||
2125 isa<ConstantExpr>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002126 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00002127 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002128 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
2129
2130 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
2131 // loop.
2132 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
2133 return 0;
2134 }
2135
2136 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
2137 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
2138 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
2139 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00002140 if (NonConstBB != 0 && !AllowAggressive) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002141 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
2142 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
2143 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002144
2145 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002146 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00002147 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner857eb572009-10-21 23:41:58 +00002148 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
2149 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002150
2151 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002152 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(&I)) {
2153 // We only currently try to fold the condition of a select when it is a phi,
2154 // not the true/false values.
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002155 Value *TrueV = SI->getTrueValue();
2156 Value *FalseV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner3ddfb212009-09-28 06:49:44 +00002157 BasicBlock *PhiTransBB = PN->getParent();
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002158 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002159 BasicBlock *ThisBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
Chris Lattner3ddfb212009-09-28 06:49:44 +00002160 Value *TrueVInPred = TrueV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
2161 Value *FalseVInPred = FalseV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002162 Value *InV = 0;
2163 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002164 InV = InC->isNullValue() ? FalseVInPred : TrueVInPred;
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002165 } else {
2166 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002167 InV = SelectInst::Create(PN->getIncomingValue(i), TrueVInPred,
2168 FalseVInPred,
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002169 "phitmp", NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner857eb572009-10-21 23:41:58 +00002170 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002171 }
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002172 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, ThisBB);
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002173 }
2174 } else if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002175 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002176 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00002177 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002178 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002179 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002180 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002181 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002182 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002183 } else {
2184 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
2185 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002186 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002187 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2188 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002189 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00002190 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002191 CI->getPredicate(),
2192 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2193 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002194 else
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00002195 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
Chris Lattner857eb572009-10-21 23:41:58 +00002196
2197 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002198 }
2199 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002200 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002201 } else {
2202 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
2203 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002204 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002205 Value *InV;
2206 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002207 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002208 } else {
2209 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002210 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002211 I.getType(), "phitmp",
2212 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner857eb572009-10-21 23:41:58 +00002213 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002214 }
2215 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002216 }
2217 }
2218 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
2219}
2220
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002221
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002222/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
2223/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
2224/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
2225/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
2226bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2227 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
2228 // ones.
2229
2230 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
2231 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
Chris Lattner8aee8ef2009-11-27 17:42:22 +00002232 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values
2233 // will sign extend fine.
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002234 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
2235 return true;
2236
2237
2238 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
2239 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
2240 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
2241 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
2242
2243 // TODO: Implement.
2244
2245 return false;
2246}
2247
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002248
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002249Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002250 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002251 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002252
Chris Lattner8aee8ef2009-11-27 17:42:22 +00002253 if (Value *V = SimplifyAddInst(LHS, RHS, I.hasNoSignedWrap(),
2254 I.hasNoUnsignedWrap(), TD))
2255 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, V);
2256
2257
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002258 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002259 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002260 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002261 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002262 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002263 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002264 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002265
2266 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2267 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002268 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00002269 return &I;
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002270
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002271 // zext(bool) + C -> bool ? C + 1 : C
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002272 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002273 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002274 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), AddOne(CI), CI);
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002275 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002276
2277 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2278 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2279 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002280
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002281 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2282 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002283 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002284 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002285 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002286 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002287
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002288 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002289 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2290 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002291 do {
2292 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002293 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2294 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002295 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2296 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002297 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002298 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2299 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002300 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002301 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002302 }
2303 }
2304 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002305 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2306 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2307 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002308
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002309 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002310 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2311 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2312 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002313 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2314 switch (Size) {
2315 default: break;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002316 case 32: MiddleType = Type::getInt32Ty(*Context); break;
2317 case 16: MiddleType = Type::getInt16Ty(*Context); break;
2318 case 8: MiddleType = Type::getInt8Ty(*Context); break;
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002319 }
2320 if (MiddleType) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002321 Value *NewTrunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002322 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002323 }
2324 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002325 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002326
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002327 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002328 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2329
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002330 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002331 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002332 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002333 return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002334
2335 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2336 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2337 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2339 }
2340 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2341 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2342 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2343 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2344 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002345 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002346
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002347 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002348 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002349 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002350 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002351 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002352 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002353 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002354 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002355 }
2356
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002357 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002358 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002359
2360 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002361 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002362 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002363 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002364
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002365
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002366 ConstantInt *C2;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002367 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002368 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002369 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002370
2371 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2372 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002373 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002374 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getAdd(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002375 }
2376
2377 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002378 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2379 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002380
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002381 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002382 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
2383 dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002385
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002386
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002387 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002388 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
2389 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002390 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002391
2392 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2393 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2394 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2395 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2396 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2397 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2398 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2399 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2400 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2401 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2402
2403 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002404 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002405 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002406 }
2407 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002408
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002409 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002410 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002411 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002412 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2413 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002414 if (W != Y) {
2415 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002416 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002417 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002418 std::swap(W, X);
2419 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002420 std::swap(Y, Z);
2421 std::swap(W, X);
2422 }
2423 }
2424
2425 if (W == Y) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002426 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, Z, LHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002427 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002428 }
2429 }
2430 }
2431
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002432 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002433 Value *X = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002434 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002435 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002436
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002437 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002438 if (LHS->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002439 match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002440 Constant *Anded = ConstantExpr::getAnd(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002441 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2442 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2443 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002444 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002445
2446 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002447 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002448
2449 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002450 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002451
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002452 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2453 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002454 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, CRHS, LHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002455 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002456 }
2457 }
2458 }
2459
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002460 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2461 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002462 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002463 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002464 }
2465
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002466 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002467 {
2468 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002469 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002470 if (!SI) {
2471 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002472 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002473 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002474 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002475 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2476 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002477 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002478
2479 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2480 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002481 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) &&
2482 match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002483 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002484 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002485 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) &&
2486 match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002487 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002488 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002489 }
2490 }
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002491
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002492 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2493 // integer add followed by a sext.
2494 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2495 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2496 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2497 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002498 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002499 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002500 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002501 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2502 // Insert the new, smaller add.
Dan Gohmanfe359552009-10-26 22:14:22 +00002503 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateNSWAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2504 CI, "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002505 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2506 }
2507 }
2508
2509 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2510 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2511 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2512 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2513 // integer add will not overflow.
2514 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2515 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2516 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2517 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2518 // Insert the new integer add.
Dan Gohmanfe359552009-10-26 22:14:22 +00002519 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateNSWAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2520 RHSConv->getOperand(0), "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002521 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2522 }
2523 }
2524 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002525
2526 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2527}
2528
2529Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
2530 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2531 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
2532
2533 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
2534 // X + 0 --> X
2535 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Owen Anderson6f83c9c2009-07-27 20:59:43 +00002536 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002537 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
2538 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2539 }
2540
2541 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2542 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2543 return NV;
2544 }
2545
2546 // -A + B --> B - A
2547 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002548 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castFNegVal(LHS))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002549 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(RHS, LHSV);
2550
2551 // A + -B --> A - B
2552 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002553 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(RHS))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002554 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, V);
2555
2556 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2557 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2558 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2560
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002561 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2562 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2563 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2564 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2565 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2566 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2567 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2568 // instcombined.
2569 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2570 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002571 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002572 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002573 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002574 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2575 // Insert the new integer add.
Dan Gohmanfe359552009-10-26 22:14:22 +00002576 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateNSWAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2577 CI, "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002578 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2579 }
2580 }
2581
2582 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2583 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2584 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2585 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2586 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2587 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2588 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2589 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2590 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2591 // Insert the new integer add.
Dan Gohmanfe359552009-10-26 22:14:22 +00002592 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateNSWAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002593 RHSConv->getOperand(0),"addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002594 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2595 }
2596 }
2597 }
2598
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002599 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002600}
2601
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002602
2603/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
2604/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
2605/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
2606static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, InstCombiner &IC) {
2607 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
2608 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
2609 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(GEP->getContext());
2610 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
2611
2612 // Build a mask for high order bits.
2613 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
2614 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
2615
2616 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
2617 ++i, ++GTI) {
2618 Value *Op = *i;
2619 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
2620 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
2621 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
2622
2623 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
2624 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
2625 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
2626
2627 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Result,
2628 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
2629 GEP->getName()+".offs");
2630 continue;
2631 }
2632
2633 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
2634 Constant *OC =
2635 ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
2636 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
2637 // Emit an add instruction.
2638 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Result, Scale, GEP->getName()+".offs");
2639 continue;
2640 }
2641 // Convert to correct type.
2642 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy)
2643 Op = IC.Builder->CreateIntCast(Op, IntPtrTy, true, Op->getName()+".c");
2644 if (Size != 1) {
2645 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
2646 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
2647 Op = IC.Builder->CreateMul(Op, Scale, GEP->getName()+".idx");
2648 }
2649
2650 // Emit an add instruction.
2651 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Op, Result, GEP->getName()+".offs");
2652 }
2653 return Result;
2654}
2655
2656
2657/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return a value that can be used to compare
2658/// the *offset* implied by a GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we
2659/// want to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can
2660/// be complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be
2661/// legal to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32).
2662/// This later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed
2663/// to generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
2664///
2665/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
2666///
2667static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
2668 InstCombiner &IC) {
2669 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
2670 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
2671
2672 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
2673 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
2674 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
2675 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
2676 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
2677 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
2678 int64_t Offset = 0;
2679 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
2680 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
2681 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
2682 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
2683
2684 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
2685 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
2686 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
2687 } else {
2688 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
2689 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
2690 }
2691 } else {
2692 // Found our variable index.
2693 break;
2694 }
2695 }
2696
2697 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
2698 // evaluate it the general way.
2699 if (i == e) return 0;
2700
2701 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
2702 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
2703 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
2704 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
2705
2706 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
2707 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
2708 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
2709 if (!CI) return 0;
2710
2711 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
2712 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
2713
2714 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
2715 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
2716 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
2717 } else {
2718 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
2719 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
2720 }
2721 }
2722
2723 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
2724 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
2725 // the index.
2726 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
2727 if (Offset == 0) {
2728 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
2729 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
2730 // computation crosses zero.
2731 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
2732 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx,
2733 TD.getIntPtrType(VariableIdx->getContext()),
2734 VariableIdx->getName(), &I);
2735 return VariableIdx;
2736 }
2737
2738 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
2739 // the pointer size, so get it.
2740 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
2741
2742 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
2743 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
2744
2745 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
2746 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
2747 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
2748 // multiple of the variable scale.
2749 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
2750 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
2751 return 0;
2752
2753 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
2754 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(VariableIdx->getContext());
2755 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
2756 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
2757 true /*SExt*/,
2758 VariableIdx->getName(), &I);
2759 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
2760 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
2761}
2762
2763
2764/// Optimize pointer differences into the same array into a size. Consider:
2765/// &A[10] - &A[0]: we should compile this to "10". LHS/RHS are the pointer
2766/// operands to the ptrtoint instructions for the LHS/RHS of the subtract.
2767///
2768Value *InstCombiner::OptimizePointerDifference(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
2769 const Type *Ty) {
2770 assert(TD && "Must have target data info for this");
2771
2772 // If LHS is a gep based on RHS or RHS is a gep based on LHS, we can optimize
2773 // this.
2774 bool Swapped;
Chris Lattner85c1c962010-01-01 22:42:29 +00002775 GetElementPtrInst *GEP = 0;
2776 ConstantExpr *CstGEP = 0;
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002777
Chris Lattner85c1c962010-01-01 22:42:29 +00002778 // TODO: Could also optimize &A[i] - &A[j] -> "i-j", and "&A.foo[i] - &A.foo".
2779 // For now we require one side to be the base pointer "A" or a constant
2780 // expression derived from it.
2781 if (GetElementPtrInst *LHSGEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(LHS)) {
2782 // (gep X, ...) - X
2783 if (LHSGEP->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
2784 GEP = LHSGEP;
2785 Swapped = false;
2786 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(RHS)) {
2787 // (gep X, ...) - (ce_gep X, ...)
2788 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr &&
2789 LHSGEP->getOperand(0) == CE->getOperand(0)) {
2790 CstGEP = CE;
2791 GEP = LHSGEP;
2792 Swapped = false;
2793 }
2794 }
2795 }
2796
2797 if (GetElementPtrInst *RHSGEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(RHS)) {
2798 // X - (gep X, ...)
2799 if (RHSGEP->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
2800 GEP = RHSGEP;
2801 Swapped = true;
2802 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(LHS)) {
2803 // (ce_gep X, ...) - (gep X, ...)
2804 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr &&
2805 RHSGEP->getOperand(0) == CE->getOperand(0)) {
2806 CstGEP = CE;
2807 GEP = RHSGEP;
2808 Swapped = true;
2809 }
2810 }
2811 }
2812
2813 if (GEP == 0)
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002814 return 0;
2815
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002816 // Emit the offset of the GEP and an intptr_t.
2817 Value *Result = EmitGEPOffset(GEP, *this);
Chris Lattner85c1c962010-01-01 22:42:29 +00002818
2819 // If we had a constant expression GEP on the other side offsetting the
2820 // pointer, subtract it from the offset we have.
2821 if (CstGEP) {
2822 Value *CstOffset = EmitGEPOffset(CstGEP, *this);
2823 Result = Builder->CreateSub(Result, CstOffset);
2824 }
2825
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002826
2827 // If we have p - gep(p, ...) then we have to negate the result.
2828 if (Swapped)
2829 Result = Builder->CreateNeg(Result, "diff.neg");
2830
2831 return Builder->CreateIntCast(Result, Ty, true);
2832}
2833
2834
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002835Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002836 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002837
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002838 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002840
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00002841 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A. This preserves NSW/NUW.
2842 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1)) {
2843 BinaryOperator *Res = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
2844 Res->setHasNoSignedWrap(I.hasNoSignedWrap());
2845 Res->setHasNoUnsignedWrap(I.hasNoUnsignedWrap());
2846 return Res;
2847 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002848
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002849 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2851 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2852 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002853 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
2854 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2855
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002856 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002857 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A).
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002858 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002859 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002860
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002861 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002862 Value *X = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002863 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002864 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002865
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002866 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2867 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002868 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002869 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002870 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002871 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002872 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002873 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002874 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002875 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002876 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002877 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002878 }
2879 }
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002880 } else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002881 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2882 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002883 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002884 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002885 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002886 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002887 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002888 }
2889 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002890 }
2891 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002892 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002893
2894 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2895 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002896 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002897 return R;
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002898
2899 // C - zext(bool) -> bool ? C - 1 : C
2900 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op1))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002901 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002902 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), SubOne(C), C);
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002903 }
2904
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002905 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002906 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002907 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002908 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002909 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002910 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002911 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002912 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002913 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2914 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2915 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002916 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002917 ConstantExpr::getSub(CI1, CI2), Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002918 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002919 }
2920
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002921 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002922 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2923 // is not used by anyone else...
2924 //
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002925 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002926 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2927 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2928 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2929 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002930
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002931 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002932 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002933 }
2934
2935 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2936 //
2937 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2938 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2939 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2940
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002941 Value *NewNot = Builder->CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002942 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002943 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002944
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002945 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002946 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002947 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002948 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002949 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002950 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002951 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002952
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002953 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002954 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002955 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002956 Constant *CP1 =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002957 ConstantExpr::getSub(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002958 C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002959 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002960 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002961 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002962 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002963
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002964 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
2965 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
2966 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2967 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2968 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
2970 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2971 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002972 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002973 I.getName());
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002974 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002975 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002976
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002977 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002978 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002979 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002980 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002981
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002982 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002983 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002984 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002985 }
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002986
2987 // Optimize pointer differences into the same array into a size. Consider:
2988 // &A[10] - &A[0]: we should compile this to "10".
2989 if (TD) {
Chris Lattner33767182010-01-01 22:12:03 +00002990 Value *LHSOp, *RHSOp;
Chris Lattnerf2ebc682010-01-01 22:29:12 +00002991 if (match(Op0, m_PtrToInt(m_Value(LHSOp))) &&
2992 match(Op1, m_PtrToInt(m_Value(RHSOp))))
Chris Lattner33767182010-01-01 22:12:03 +00002993 if (Value *Res = OptimizePointerDifference(LHSOp, RHSOp, I.getType()))
2994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Res);
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00002995
2996 // trunc(p)-trunc(q) -> trunc(p-q)
Chris Lattnerf2ebc682010-01-01 22:29:12 +00002997 if (match(Op0, m_Trunc(m_PtrToInt(m_Value(LHSOp)))) &&
2998 match(Op1, m_Trunc(m_PtrToInt(m_Value(RHSOp)))))
2999 if (Value *Res = OptimizePointerDifference(LHSOp, RHSOp, I.getType()))
3000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Res);
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00003001 }
3002
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003003 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00003004}
3005
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003006Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
3007 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3008
3009 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003010 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003011 return BinaryOperator::CreateFAdd(Op0, V);
3012
3013 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3014 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd) {
3015 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003016 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00003017 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003018 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003019 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00003020 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003021 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003022 }
3023
3024 return 0;
3025}
3026
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00003027/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
3028/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
3029/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
3030/// signed.
3031static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
3032 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003033 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00003034 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
3035 TrueIfSigned = true;
3036 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00003037 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
3038 TrueIfSigned = true;
3039 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00003040 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
3041 TrueIfSigned = false;
3042 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00003043 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3044 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
3045 TrueIfSigned = true;
3046 return RHS->getValue() ==
3047 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
3048 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
3049 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
3050 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00003051 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00003052 default:
3053 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00003054 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00003055}
3056
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003057Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003058 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003059 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00003060
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003061 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // undef * X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003062 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003063
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00003064 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS.
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003065 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
3066 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1C)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00003067
3068 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003069 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00003070 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3071 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003072 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003073 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003074
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00003075 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003076 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1C); // X * 0 == 0
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00003077 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
3078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3079 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003080 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00003081
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00003082 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003083 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003084 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003085 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00003086 }
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003087 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1C->getType())) {
3088 if (Op1C->isNullValue())
3089 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1C);
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003090
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003091 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1C)) {
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003092 if (Op1V->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003093 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003094
3095 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
3096 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003097 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Splat))
3098 if (CI->equalsInt(1))
3099 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3100 }
3101 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003102 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00003103
3104 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3105 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003106 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1C)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00003107 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003108 Value *Add = Builder->CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1C, "tmp");
3109 Value *C1C2 = Builder->CreateMul(Op1C, Op0I->getOperand(1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003110 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00003111
3112 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003113
3114 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
3115 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003116 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003117 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003118
3119 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3120 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3121 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00003122 }
3123
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003124 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003125 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003126 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00003127
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003128 // (X / Y) * Y = X - (X % Y)
3129 // (X / Y) * -Y = (X % Y) - X
3130 {
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003131 Value *Op1C = Op1;
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003132 BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
3133 if (!BO ||
3134 (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::UDiv &&
3135 BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::SDiv)) {
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003136 Op1C = Op0;
3137 BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003138 }
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003139 Value *Neg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1C);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003140 if (BO && BO->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003141 (BO->getOperand(1) == Op1C || BO->getOperand(1) == Neg) &&
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003142 (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv ||
3143 BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)) {
3144 Value *Op0BO = BO->getOperand(0), *Op1BO = BO->getOperand(1);
3145
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00003146 // If the division is exact, X % Y is zero.
3147 if (SDivOperator *SDiv = dyn_cast<SDivOperator>(BO))
3148 if (SDiv->isExact()) {
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003149 if (Op1BO == Op1C)
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00003150 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0BO);
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003151 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0BO);
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00003152 }
3153
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003154 Value *Rem;
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003155 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003156 Rem = Builder->CreateURem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003157 else
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003158 Rem = Builder->CreateSRem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003159 Rem->takeName(BO);
3160
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003161 if (Op1BO == Op1C)
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003162 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Op0BO, Rem);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003163 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Rem, Op0BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00003164 }
3165 }
3166
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00003167 /// i1 mul -> i1 and.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00003168 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003169 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Op1);
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00003170
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00003171 // X*(1 << Y) --> X << Y
3172 // (1 << Y)*X --> X << Y
3173 {
3174 Value *Y;
3175 if (match(Op0, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003176 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op1, Y);
3177 if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00003178 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0, Y);
3179 }
3180
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00003181 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
3182 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
Chris Lattnerd2c58362009-10-11 21:29:45 +00003183 // X * Y (where Y is 0 or 1) -> X & (0-Y)
3184 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3185 // -2 is "-1 << 1" so it is all bits set except the low one.
Dale Johannesenc1deda52009-10-12 18:45:32 +00003186 APInt Negative2(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), (uint64_t)-2, true);
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00003187
Chris Lattnerd2c58362009-10-11 21:29:45 +00003188 Value *BoolCast = 0, *OtherOp = 0;
3189 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Negative2))
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003190 BoolCast = Op0, OtherOp = Op1;
3191 else if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Negative2))
3192 BoolCast = Op1, OtherOp = Op0;
Chris Lattnerd2c58362009-10-11 21:29:45 +00003193
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00003194 if (BoolCast) {
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00003195 Value *V = Builder->CreateSub(Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
3196 BoolCast, "tmp");
3197 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00003198 }
3199 }
3200
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003201 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00003202}
3203
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003204Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
3205 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003206 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003207
3208 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003209 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
3210 if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1C)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003211 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
3212 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
3213 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
3214 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003215 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1C->getType())) {
3216 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1C)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003217 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
3218 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
3219 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Splat))
3220 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
3221 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3222 }
3223 }
3224 }
3225
3226 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
3227 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
3228 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3229 return R;
3230
3231 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3232 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3233 return NV;
3234 }
3235
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003236 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00003237 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00003238 return BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(Op0v, Op1v);
3239
3240 return Changed ? &I : 0;
3241}
3242
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003243/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
3244/// instruction.
3245bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
3246 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
3247
3248 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
3249 int NonNullOperand = -1;
3250 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3251 if (ST->isNullValue())
3252 NonNullOperand = 2;
3253 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
3254 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
3255 if (ST->isNullValue())
3256 NonNullOperand = 1;
3257
3258 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
3259 return false;
3260
3261 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
3262
3263 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
3264 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
3265
3266 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
3267 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
3268 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
3269 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
3270 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
3271
3272 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
3273 // early exit.
3274 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
3275 return true;
3276
3277 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
3278 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
3279
3280 while (BBI != BBFront) {
3281 --BBI;
3282 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
3283 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
3284 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
3285 break;
3286
3287 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
3288 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
3289 I != E; ++I) {
3290 if (*I == SI) {
3291 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00003292 Worklist.Add(BBI);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003293 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003294 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) :
3295 ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00003296 Worklist.Add(BBI);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003297 }
3298 }
3299
3300 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
3301 if (&*BBI == SI)
3302 SI = 0;
3303 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
3304 SelectCond = 0;
3305
3306 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
3307 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
3308 break;
3309
3310 }
3311 return true;
3312}
3313
3314
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003315/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
3316/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
3317/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
3318/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003319Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003320 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003321
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003322 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
3323 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
3324 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
3325 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
3326 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003327 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003328 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003329
3330 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003331 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003332 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003333
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003334 return 0;
3335}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003336
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003337/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
3338/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
3339/// division instructions.
3340/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003341Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003342 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3343
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00003344 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00003345 if (Op0 == Op1) {
3346 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003347 Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00003348 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00003349 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00003350 }
3351
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003352 Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00003353 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
3354 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00003355
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003356 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
3357 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003358
3359 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
3360 // This does not apply for fdiv.
3361 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
3362 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003363
3364 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3365 // div X, 1 == X
3366 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
3367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3368
3369 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
3370 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
3371 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
3372 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003373 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003374 I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00003376 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003377 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003378 ConstantExpr::getMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00003379 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003380
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003381 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003382 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
3383 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3384 return R;
3385 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3386 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3387 return NV;
3388 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003389 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003390
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003391 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003392 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003393 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003394 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003395
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00003396 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00003397 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00003398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3399
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003400 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3401 if (ConstantInt *X = cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
3402 // div X, 1 == X
3403 if (X->isOne())
3404 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3405 }
3406
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003407 return 0;
3408}
3409
3410Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3411 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3412
3413 // Handle the integer div common cases
3414 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3415 return Common;
3416
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003417 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003418 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
3419 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
3420 // if so, convert to a right shift.
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003421 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003422 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003423 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003424
3425 // X udiv C, where C >= signbit
3426 if (C->getValue().isNegative()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003427 Value *IC = Builder->CreateICmpULT( Op0, C);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003428 return SelectInst::Create(IC, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003429 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003430 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003431 }
3432
3433 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003434 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003435 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3436 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003437 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003438 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003439 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003440 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003441 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2())
3442 N = Builder->CreateAdd(N, ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2), "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003443 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003444 }
3445 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00003446 }
3447
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003448 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
3449 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003450 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003451 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003452 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003453 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003454 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003455 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003456 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003457 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003458 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003459 Value *TSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003460
3461 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003462 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003463 Value *FSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003464
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003465 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003466 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003467 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003468 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003469 return 0;
3470}
3471
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003472Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3473 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3474
3475 // Handle the integer div common cases
3476 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3477 return Common;
3478
3479 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3480 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
3481 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003482 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Dan Gohman1bdf5dc2009-08-11 20:47:47 +00003483
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00003484 // sdiv X, C --> ashr X, log2(C)
Dan Gohman1bdf5dc2009-08-11 20:47:47 +00003485 if (cast<SDivOperator>(&I)->isExact() &&
3486 RHS->getValue().isNonNegative() &&
3487 RHS->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3488 Value *ShAmt = llvm::ConstantInt::get(RHS->getType(),
3489 RHS->getValue().exactLogBase2());
3490 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(Op0, ShAmt, I.getName());
3491 }
Dan Gohman9ca9daa2009-08-12 16:37:02 +00003492
3493 // -X/C --> X/-C provided the negation doesn't overflow.
3494 if (SubOperator *Sub = dyn_cast<SubOperator>(Op0))
3495 if (isa<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0)) &&
3496 cast<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0))->isNullValue() &&
Dan Gohman5078f842009-08-20 17:11:38 +00003497 Sub->hasNoSignedWrap())
Dan Gohman9ca9daa2009-08-12 16:37:02 +00003498 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Sub->getOperand(1),
3499 ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003500 }
3501
3502 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
3503 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003504 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003505 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003506 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3507 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask)) {
3508 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
3509 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3510 }
3511 ConstantInt *ShiftedInt;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003512 if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_ConstantInt(ShiftedInt), m_Value())) &&
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003513 ShiftedInt->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3514 // X sdiv (1 << Y) -> X udiv (1 << Y) ( -> X u>> Y)
3515 // Safe because the only negative value (1 << Y) can take on is
3516 // INT_MIN, and X sdiv INT_MIN == X udiv INT_MIN == 0 if X doesn't have
3517 // the sign bit set.
3518 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3519 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003520 }
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003521 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003522
3523 return 0;
3524}
3525
3526Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3527 return commonDivTransforms(I);
3528}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003529
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003530/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
3531/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
3532/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
3533/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
3534Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003535 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003536
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003537 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
3538 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
3539 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003540 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003541 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003542 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3543 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003544
3545 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003546 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
3547 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00003548
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003549 return 0;
3550}
3551
3552/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
3553/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
3554/// remainder instructions.
3555/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
3556Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
3557 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3558
3559 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
3560 return common;
3561
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003562 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
3563 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
3564 if (LHS->isNullValue())
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003565 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003566
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003567 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003568 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
3569 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00003570 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003571
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003572 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003573 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003574
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003575 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
3576 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
3577 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3578 return R;
3579 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
3580 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3581 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003582 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003583
3584 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00003585 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003586 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003587 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003588 }
3589
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003590 return 0;
3591}
3592
3593Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3594 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3595
3596 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3597 return common;
3598
3599 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3600 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3601 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3602 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3603 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003604 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003605 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003606 }
3607
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003608 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003609 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3610 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3611 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003612 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003613 Constant *N1 = Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003614 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(RHSI, N1, "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003615 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003616 }
3617 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003618 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003619
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003620 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3621 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3622 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3623 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3624 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3625 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003626 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3627 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003628 Value *TrueAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO),
3629 SI->getName()+".t");
3630 Value *FalseAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO),
3631 SI->getName()+".f");
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003632 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003633 }
3634 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003635 }
3636
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003637 return 0;
3638}
3639
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003640Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3641 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3642
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003643 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +00003644 if (Instruction *Common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3645 return Common;
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003646
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003647 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003648 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3649 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3650 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003651 // X % -Y -> X % Y
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +00003652 Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003653 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3654 return &I;
3655 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003656
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003657 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003658 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003659 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3660 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3661 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3662 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003663 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003664 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003665 }
3666
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003667 // If it's a constant vector, flip any negative values positive.
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003668 if (ConstantVector *RHSV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3669 unsigned VWidth = RHSV->getNumOperands();
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003670
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003671 bool hasNegative = false;
3672 for (unsigned i = 0; !hasNegative && i != VWidth; ++i)
3673 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i)))
3674 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
3675 hasNegative = true;
3676
3677 if (hasNegative) {
3678 std::vector<Constant *> Elts(VWidth);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003679 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
3680 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i))) {
3681 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003682 Elts[i] = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003683 else
3684 Elts[i] = RHS;
3685 }
3686 }
3687
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00003688 Constant *NewRHSV = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003689 if (NewRHSV != RHSV) {
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +00003690 Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003691 I.setOperand(1, NewRHSV);
3692 return &I;
3693 }
3694 }
3695 }
3696
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003697 return 0;
3698}
3699
3700Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003701 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3702}
3703
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003704// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3705// constant.
3706static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003707 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003708}
3709
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003710// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3711// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3712static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003713 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003714}
3715
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003716/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003717/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3718///
3719/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3720///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003721/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3722/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003723///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003724/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3725/// 0 A > B
3726/// 1 A == B
3727/// 2 A < B
3728///
3729/// <=> Value Definition
3730/// 000 0 Always false
3731/// 001 1 A > B
3732/// 010 2 A == B
3733/// 011 3 A >= B
3734/// 100 4 A < B
3735/// 101 5 A != B
3736/// 110 6 A <= B
3737/// 111 7 Always true
3738///
3739static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3740 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003741 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003742 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3743 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3744 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3745 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3747 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3749 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3750 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3751 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003752 // True -> 7
3753 default:
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003754 llvm_unreachable("Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003755 return 0;
3756 }
3757}
3758
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003759/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3760/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3761/// predicate by reference.
3762static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3763 isOrdered = false;
3764 switch (CC) {
3765 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3766 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003767 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3768 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3769 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3770 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003771 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3772 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3773 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3774 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003775 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3776 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003777 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3778 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003779 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003780 default:
3781 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003782 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003783 return 0;
3784 }
3785}
3786
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003787/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3788/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003789/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003790/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003791static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003792 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003793 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003794 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal ICmp code!");
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003795 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003796 case 1:
3797 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003798 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003799 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003800 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3801 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003802 case 3:
3803 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003804 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003805 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003806 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003807 case 4:
3808 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003809 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003810 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003811 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3812 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003813 case 6:
3814 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003815 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003816 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003817 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003818 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003819 }
3820}
3821
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003822/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3823/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3824/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3825static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003826 Value *LHS, Value *RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003827 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003828 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003829 case 0:
3830 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003831 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003832 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003833 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003834 case 1:
3835 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003836 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003837 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003838 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003839 case 2:
3840 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003841 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003842 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003843 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003844 case 3:
3845 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003846 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003847 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003848 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003849 case 4:
3850 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003851 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003852 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003853 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003854 case 5:
3855 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003856 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003857 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003858 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003859 case 6:
3860 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003861 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003862 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003863 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003864 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003865 }
3866}
3867
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003868/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3869/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003870static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00003871 return (CmpInst::isSigned(p1) == CmpInst::isSigned(p2)) ||
3872 (CmpInst::isSigned(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3873 (CmpInst::isSigned(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003874}
3875
3876namespace {
3877// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3878struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003879 InstCombiner &IC;
3880 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003881 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3882 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3883 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3884 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003885 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003886 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3887 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003888 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3889 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003890 return false;
3891 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003892 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3893 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3894 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3895 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3896 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003897 }
3898
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003899 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003900 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003901 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003902 unsigned Code;
3903 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3904 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3905 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3906 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003907 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003908 }
3909
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00003910 bool isSigned = RHSICI->isSigned() || ICI->isSigned();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003911 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS, IC.getContext());
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003912 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3913 return I;
3914 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3915 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3916 }
3917};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003918} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003919
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003920// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3921// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003922// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003923Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003924 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3925 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003926 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3927 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003928 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003929 if (!Op->isShift())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003930 Together = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003931
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003932 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3933 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003934 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003935 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003936 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003937 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003938 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003939 }
3940 break;
3941 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003942 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3943 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003944
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003945 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3946 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003947 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003948 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003949 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003950 }
3951 break;
3952 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003953 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003954 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3955 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3956 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003957 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003958
3959 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003960 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003961 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3962 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3963 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003964 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003965
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003966 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3967 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3968 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3969 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3970 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3971 // no effect.
3972 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3973 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3974 return &TheAnd;
3975 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003976 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003977 Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003978 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003979 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003980 }
3981 }
3982 }
3983 }
3984 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003985
3986 case Instruction::Shl: {
3987 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3988 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3989 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003990 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003991 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003992 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003993 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003994
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003995 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3996 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3998 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003999 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
4000 return &TheAnd;
4001 }
4002 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004003 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004004 case Instruction::LShr:
4005 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00004006 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
4007 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
4008 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
4009 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00004010 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00004011 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00004012 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004013 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00004014
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00004015 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
4016 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004017 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
4018 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
4019 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
4020 return &TheAnd;
4021 }
4022 break;
4023 }
4024 case Instruction::AShr:
4025 // Signed shr.
4026 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
4027 // with an and.
4028 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00004029 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00004030 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00004031 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004032 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00004033 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00004034 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004035 // Make the argument unsigned.
4036 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004037 ShVal = Builder->CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS, Op->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004038 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00004039 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00004040 }
4041 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004042 }
4043 return 0;
4044}
4045
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004046
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004047/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
4048/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004049/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
4050/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004051/// insert new instructions.
4052Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004053 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
4054 Instruction &IB) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004055 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004056 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004057 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004058
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004059 if (Inside) {
4060 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004061 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004062
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004063 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004064 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004065 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004066 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004067 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004068 }
4069
4070 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004071 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004072 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004073 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004074 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004075 }
4076
4077 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004078 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004079
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004080 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004081 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004082 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004083 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
4084 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004085 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004086 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004087
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004088 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
4089 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004090 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004091 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004092 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004093 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004094}
4095
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004096// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
4097// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
4098// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
4099// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00004100static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004101 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00004102 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
4103 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004104
4105 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00004106 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004107 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00004108 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004109 return true;
4110}
4111
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004112/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
4113/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
4114/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004115///
4116/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
4117/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
4118/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
4119///
4120/// return (A +/- B).
4121///
4122Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004123 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004124 Instruction &I) {
4125 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
4126 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
4127 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
4128
4129 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
4130
4131 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4132 default: return 0;
4133 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004134 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004135 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00004136 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
4137 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
4138 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004139 break;
4140
4141 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
4142 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
4143 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00004144 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004145 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00004146 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00004147 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00004148 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004149 break;
4150 }
4151 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004152 return 0;
4153 case Instruction::Or:
4154 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004155 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00004156 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
4157 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004158 && ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004159 break;
4160 return 0;
4161 }
4162
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004163 if (isSub)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004164 return Builder->CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
4165 return Builder->CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004166}
4167
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004168/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
4169Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4170 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00004171 Value *Val, *Val2;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004172 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4173 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4174
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00004175 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004176 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004177 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004178 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004179 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004180 return 0;
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00004181
Chris Lattner3f40e232009-11-29 00:51:17 +00004182 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC) {
4183 // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
4184 // where C is a power of 2
4185 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
4186 LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
4187 Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
4188 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
4189 }
4190
4191 // (icmp eq A, 0) & (icmp eq B, 0) --> (icmp eq (A|B), 0)
4192 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && LHSCst->isZero()) {
4193 Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
4194 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
4195 }
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00004196 }
4197
4198 // From here on, we only handle:
4199 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4200 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4201
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004202 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4203 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4204 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4205 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4206 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4207 return 0;
4208
4209 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
4210 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4211 return 0;
4212
4213 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00004214 bool ShouldSwap;
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00004215 if (CmpInst::isSigned(LHSCC) ||
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004216 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00004217 CmpInst::isSigned(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00004218 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004219 else
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00004220 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4221
4222 if (ShouldSwap) {
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004223 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4224 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4225 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4226 }
4227
4228 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4229 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
4230 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4231 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
4232 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
4233 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
4234 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4235
4236 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004237 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004238 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4239 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004240 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004241 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
4242 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
4243 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004245 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
4246 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
4247 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
4248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4249 }
4250 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4251 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004252 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004253 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004254 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004255 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004256 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
4257 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004258 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004259 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004260 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
4261 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
4262 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
4263 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
4264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4265 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004266 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004267 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004268 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004269 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004270 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004271 }
4272 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
4273 }
4274 break;
4275 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4276 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004277 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004278 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
4279 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004281 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
4282 break;
4283 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
4284 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
4285 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4286 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
4287 break;
4288 }
4289 break;
4290 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4291 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004292 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004293 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
4294 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004295 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004296 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
4297 break;
4298 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
4299 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
4300 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4301 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
4302 break;
4303 }
4304 break;
4305 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4306 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004307 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004308 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
4309 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
4310 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4311 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
4312 break;
4313 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004314 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004315 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004316 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004317 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004318 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004319 RHSCst, false, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004320 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
4321 break;
4322 }
4323 break;
4324 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4325 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004326 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004327 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
4328 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
4329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4330 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
4331 break;
4332 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004333 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004334 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004335 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004336 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004337 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004338 RHSCst, true, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004339 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
4340 break;
4341 }
4342 break;
4343 }
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004344
4345 return 0;
4346}
4347
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004348Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
4349 FCmpInst *RHS) {
4350
4351 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
4352 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
4353 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
4354 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4355 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4356 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4357 // false.
4358 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004360 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004361 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4362 }
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004363
4364 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
4365 // "fcmp ord x,x" is "fcmp ord x, 0".
4366 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
4367 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004368 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004369 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004370 return 0;
4371 }
4372
4373 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
4374 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
4375 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
4376
4377
4378 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4379 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4380 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4381 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4382 }
4383
4384 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4385 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4386 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004387 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004388
4389 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004390 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004391 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4393 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4394 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4395
4396 bool Op0Ordered;
4397 bool Op1Ordered;
4398 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4399 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4400 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4401 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4402 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4403 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4404 }
4405 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4406 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4407 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4408 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4409 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4410
4411 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4412 // uno && ord -> false
4413 if (!Op0Ordered)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004414 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004415 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4416 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4417 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context));
4418 }
4419 }
4420
4421 return 0;
4422}
4423
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004424
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004425Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004426 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004427 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004428
Chris Lattnerd06094f2009-11-10 00:55:12 +00004429 if (Value *V = SimplifyAndInst(Op0, Op1, TD))
4430 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, V);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004431
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004432 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00004433 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004434 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4435 return &I;
Chris Lattnerd06094f2009-11-10 00:55:12 +00004436
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004437
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004438 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00004439 const APInt &AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004440 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004441
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004442 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00004443 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004444 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
4445 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
4446 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00004447 default: break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004448 case Instruction::Xor:
4449 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004450 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00004451 if (!Op0I->hasOneUse()) break;
4452
4453 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4454 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
4455 Value *NewRHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
4456 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
4457 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0I->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
4458 }
4459 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
4460 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4461 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
4462 Value *NewLHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
4463 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
4464 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0I->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004465 }
4466
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004467 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004468 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004469 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4470 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4471 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4472 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004473 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004474 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004475 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004476 break;
4477
4478 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004479 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4480 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4481 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4482 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004483 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004484
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004485 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
4486 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
4487 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4488 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
4489 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
4490 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
4491
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004492 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004493 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
4494 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004495 Value *NewNeg = Builder->CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004496 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
4497 }
4498 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004499 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004500
4501 case Instruction::Shl:
4502 case Instruction::LShr:
4503 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
4504 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00004505 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004506 Value *NewICmp =
4507 Builder->CreateICmpEQ(Op0RHS, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004508 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
4509 }
4510 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004511 }
4512
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00004513 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004514 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004515 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004516 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004517 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
4518 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
4519 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
4520 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004521 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004522 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner48b59ec2009-10-26 15:40:07 +00004523 if (ConstantInt *AndCI =dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))){
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004524 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
4525 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004526 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
4527 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
4528 // other simplifications.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004529 Value *NewCast = Builder->CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00004530 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
4531 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004532 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004533 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004534 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004535 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004536 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4537 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
4538 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004539 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004540 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004541 // trunc(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004542 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
4543 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004544 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004545 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00004546 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004547
4548 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4549 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004550 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004551 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004552 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4553 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4554 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00004555 }
4556
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004557
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004558 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerd06094f2009-11-10 00:55:12 +00004559 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0))
4560 if (Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1))
4561 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
4562 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
4563 I.getName()+".demorgan");
4564 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
4565 }
4566
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004567 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004568 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerd06094f2009-11-10 00:55:12 +00004569 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
4570 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4571 match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) &&
4572 ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C)))
4573 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004574
Chris Lattnerd06094f2009-11-10 00:55:12 +00004575 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
4576 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4577 match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) &&
4578 ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C)))
4579 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004580
4581 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004582 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004583 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
4584 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4585 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4586 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
4587 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
4588 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4589 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4590 }
4591 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004592
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004593 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004594 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004595 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
4596 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
4597 std::swap(A, B);
4598 }
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004599 if (A == Op0) // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
4600 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(B, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004601 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004602
4603 // (A&((~A)|B)) -> A&B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004604 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)), m_Value(A))) ||
4605 match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)))))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004606 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op1);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004607 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)), m_Value(A))) ||
4608 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)))))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004609 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004610 }
4611
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004612 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
4613 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004614 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004615 return R;
4616
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004617 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
4618 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4619 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00004620 }
4621
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004622 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004623 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
4624 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4625 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
4626 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004627 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
4628 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004629 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004630 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4631 I.getType(), TD) &&
4632 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4633 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004634 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4635 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004636 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004637 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004638 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004639
4640 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004641 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4642 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4643 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004644 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4645 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004646 Value *NewOp =
4647 Builder->CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
4648 SI0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004649 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004650 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004651 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004652 }
4653
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004654 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004655 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004656 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4657 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4658 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004659 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004660
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004661 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004662}
4663
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004664/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4665/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4666/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4667/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4668/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4669/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4670/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4671/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4672/// match.
4673///
4674/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4675/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4676/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4677/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4678/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4679/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4680///
4681/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4682/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4683/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4684/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4685/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4686///
4687static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4688 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4689 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4690 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4691 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4692 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4693 ByteValues) ||
4694 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4695 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004696 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004697
4698 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4699 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4700 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4701 unsigned ShAmt =
4702 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4703 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4704 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4705 return true;
4706
4707 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4708 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4709 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4710 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4711 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4712 } else {
4713 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4714 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4715 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004716 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004717 }
4718
4719 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4720 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4721
4722 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4723 ByteValues);
4724 }
4725
4726 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4727 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4728 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4729 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4730 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4731 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4732 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4733 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4734
4735 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4736 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4737 // the and mask is.
4738 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4739 continue;
4740
4741 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4742 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4743 if (MaskB == 0) {
4744 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4745 continue;
4746 }
4747
4748 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4749 if (MaskB != Byte)
4750 return true;
4751
4752 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4753 }
4754
4755 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4756 ByteValues);
4757 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004758 }
4759
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004760 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4761 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4762 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4763 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4764 // their ultimate destination.
4765 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4766 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004767
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004768 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4769 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4770 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4771 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4772 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4773 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4774 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4775 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4776 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4777 return true;
4778 } else {
4779 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4780 return true;
4781 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004782
4783 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4784 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004785 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004786 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004787 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004788 return false;
4789}
4790
4791/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4792/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4793Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004794 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004795 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4796 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4797 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004798 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004799
4800 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4801 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004802 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004803 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004804
4805 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004806 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4807 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004808 return 0;
4809
4810 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4811 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4812 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4813
4814 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4815 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4816 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4817 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004818 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004819 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004820 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004821 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004822}
4823
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004824/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4825/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4826/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4827static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004828 Value *C, Value *D,
4829 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004830 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004831 Value *Cond = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004832 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Value(Cond))))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004833 return 0;
4834
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004835 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004836 if (match(D, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004837 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004838 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004839 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4840 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004841 if (match(B, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004842 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004843 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004844 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004845 return 0;
4846}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004847
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004848/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
4849Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4850 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
4851 Value *Val, *Val2;
4852 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4853 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4854
4855 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
Chris Lattner3f40e232009-11-29 00:51:17 +00004856 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
4857 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004858 return 0;
Chris Lattner3f40e232009-11-29 00:51:17 +00004859
4860
4861 // (icmp ne A, 0) | (icmp ne B, 0) --> (icmp ne (A|B), 0)
4862 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC &&
4863 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && LHSCst->isZero()) {
4864 Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
4865 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
4866 }
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004867
4868 // From here on, we only handle:
4869 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4870 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4871
4872 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4873 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4874 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4875 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4876 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4877 return 0;
4878
4879 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4880 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4881 return 0;
4882
4883 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4884 bool ShouldSwap;
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00004885 if (CmpInst::isSigned(LHSCC) ||
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004886 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00004887 CmpInst::isSigned(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004888 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4889 else
4890 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4891
4892 if (ShouldSwap) {
4893 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4894 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4895 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4896 }
4897
4898 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4899 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4900 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4901 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4902 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4903 // equal.
4904 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4905
4906 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004907 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4909 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004910 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004912 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004913 // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004914 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004915 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004916 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004917 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004918 }
4919 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4921 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4922 break;
4923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4924 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4925 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4927 }
4928 break;
4929 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4930 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004931 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004932 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4933 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4934 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4935 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4936 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4937 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4938 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004940 }
4941 break;
4942 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4943 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004944 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004945 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4946 break;
4947 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4948 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4949 // this can cause overflow.
4950 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004952 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004953 false, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004954 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4955 break;
4956 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4957 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4958 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4959 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4960 break;
4961 }
4962 break;
4963 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4964 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004965 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004966 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4967 break;
4968 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4969 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4970 // this can cause overflow.
4971 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4972 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004973 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004974 true, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004975 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4976 break;
4977 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4978 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4979 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4980 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4981 break;
4982 }
4983 break;
4984 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4985 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004986 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004987 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4988 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4989 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4990 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4991 break;
4992 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4993 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004995 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4996 break;
4997 }
4998 break;
4999 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5000 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005001 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00005002 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
5003 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
5004 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
5005 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
5006 break;
5007 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
5008 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00005010 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
5011 break;
5012 }
5013 break;
5014 }
5015 return 0;
5016}
5017
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005018Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
5019 FCmpInst *RHS) {
5020 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
5021 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
5022 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
5023 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
5024 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
5025 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
5026 // true.
5027 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005029
5030 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
5031 // rest.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005032 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005033 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
5034 }
5035
5036 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
5037 // "fcmp uno x,x" is "fcmp uno x, 0".
5038 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
5039 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005040 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005041 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
5042
5043 return 0;
5044 }
5045
5046 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
5047 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
5048 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
5049
5050 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
5051 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
5052 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
5053 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
5054 }
5055 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
5056 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
5057 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005058 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005059 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
5060 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005062 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5063 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
5064 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5065 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
5066 bool Op0Ordered;
5067 bool Op1Ordered;
5068 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
5069 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
5070 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
5071 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
5072 // or'ed predicates.
5073 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
5074 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context);
5075 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
5076 return I;
5077 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
5078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
5079 }
5080 }
5081 return 0;
5082}
5083
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00005084/// FoldOrWithConstants - This helper function folds:
5085///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00005086/// ((A | B) & C1) | (B & C2)
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00005087///
5088/// into:
5089///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00005090/// (A & C1) | B
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00005091///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00005092/// when the XOR of the two constants is "all ones" (-1).
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00005093Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00005094 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C) {
Bill Wendlingdda74e02008-12-02 05:06:43 +00005095 ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
5096 if (!CI1) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00005097
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00005098 Value *V1 = 0;
5099 ConstantInt *CI2 = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005100 if (!match(Op, m_And(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CI2)))) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00005101
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00005102 APInt Xor = CI1->getValue() ^ CI2->getValue();
5103 if (!Xor.isAllOnesValue()) return 0;
5104
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00005105 if (V1 == A || V1 == B) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005106 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd((V1 == A) ? B : A, CI1);
Bill Wendlingd16c6e92008-12-02 06:22:04 +00005107 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NewOp, V1);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00005108 }
5109
5110 return 0;
5111}
5112
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005113Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00005114 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005115 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005116
Chris Lattnerd06094f2009-11-10 00:55:12 +00005117 if (Value *V = SimplifyOrInst(Op0, Op1, TD))
5118 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, V);
5119
5120
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005121 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5122 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005123 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
5124 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00005125
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005126 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00005127 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00005128 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005129 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005130 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005131 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005132 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005133 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005134 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00005135 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00005136
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00005137 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005138 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005139 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005140 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005141 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005142 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005143 ConstantInt::get(*Context, C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00005144 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005145
5146 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5147 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005148 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005149 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00005150 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5151 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5152 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00005153 }
5154
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00005155 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
5156 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00005157
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00005158 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
5159 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005160 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
5161 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
5162 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
5163 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00005164 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
5165 return BSwap;
5166 }
5167
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00005168 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005169 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005170 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00005171 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005172 Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005173 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005174 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00005175 }
5176
5177 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005178 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005179 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00005180 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005181 Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005182 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005183 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00005184 }
5185
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00005186 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00005187 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005188 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
5189 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00005190 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
5191 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
5192 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
5193 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
5194 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
5195 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
5196 // replace with V+N.
5197 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
5198 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005199 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00005200 // Add commutes, try both ways.
5201 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
5202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
5203 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
5204 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
5205 }
5206 // Or commutes, try both ways.
5207 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005208 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00005209 // Add commutes, try both ways.
5210 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
5211 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
5212 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
5213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
5214 }
5215 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00005216 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00005217 }
5218
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00005219 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
5220 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00005221 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
5222 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
5223 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
5224 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
5225 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
5226 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
5227 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
5228 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
5229 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
5230
5231 if (V1) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005232 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005233 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00005234 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00005235 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00005236
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00005237 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005238 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00005239 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005240 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00005241 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005242 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00005243 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005244 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00005245 return Match;
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00005246
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00005247 // ((A&~B)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005248 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
5249 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00005250 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00005251 // ((~B&A)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005252 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
5253 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00005254 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00005255 // ((A&~B)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005256 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
5257 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00005258 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00005259 // ((~B&A)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005260 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
5261 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00005262 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, B);
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00005263 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00005264
5265 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005266 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
5267 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5268 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00005269 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
5270 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005271 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
5272 SI0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005273 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005274 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00005275 }
5276 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00005277
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00005278 // ((A|B)&1)|(B&-2) -> (A&1) | B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005279 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
5280 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00005281 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op1, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00005282 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00005283 }
5284 // (B&-2)|((A|B)&1) -> (A&1) | B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005285 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
5286 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00005287 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op0, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00005288 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00005289 }
5290
Chris Lattnerd06094f2009-11-10 00:55:12 +00005291 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
5292 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0))
5293 if (Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1))
5294 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
5295 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
5296 I.getName()+".demorgan");
5297 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
5298 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005299
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005300 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
5301 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005302 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00005303 return R;
5304
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00005305 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
5306 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
5307 return Res;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00005308 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005309
5310 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005311 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005312 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005313 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00005314 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
5315 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
5316 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00005317 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
5318 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00005319 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
5320 // generated.
5321 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5322 I.getType(), TD) &&
5323 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5324 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005325 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
5326 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005327 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00005328 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005329 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005330 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005331 }
5332
5333
5334 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
5335 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005336 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
5337 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
5338 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005339 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00005340
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005341 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005342}
5343
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005344namespace {
5345
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005346// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
5347struct XorSelf {
5348 Value *RHS;
5349 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
5350 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
5351 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
5352 return &Xor;
5353 }
5354};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005355
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005356}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005357
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005358Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00005359 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005360 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005361
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005362 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
5363 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
5364 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
5365 // idiom (misuse).
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005366 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005368 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005369
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005370 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005371 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00005372 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005374 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005375
5376 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5377 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005378 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
5379 return &I;
5380 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType()))
5381 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
5382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005383
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005384 // Is this a ~ operation?
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005385 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005386 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
5387 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
5388 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
Chris Lattner48b59ec2009-10-26 15:40:07 +00005389 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5390 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5391 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
5392 Op0I->swapOperands();
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005393 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005394 Value *NotY =
5395 Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
5396 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005397 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005398 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005399 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005400 }
Chris Lattner48b59ec2009-10-26 15:40:07 +00005401
5402 // ~(X & Y) --> (~X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5403 // ~(X | Y) === (~X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5404 if (isFreeToInvert(Op0I->getOperand(0)) &&
5405 isFreeToInvert(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5406 Value *NotX =
5407 Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(0), "notlhs");
5408 Value *NotY =
5409 Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1), "notrhs");
5410 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
5411 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotX, NotY);
5412 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotX, NotY);
5413 }
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005414 }
5415 }
5416 }
5417
5418
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005419 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00005420 if (RHS->isOne() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Bill Wendling3479be92009-01-01 01:18:23 +00005421 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005422 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005423 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005424 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00005425
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005426 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005427 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005428 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
5429 }
5430
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005431 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
5432 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5433 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
5434 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
5435 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005436 if ((Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) &&
5437 (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode,
5438 ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
5439 Op0C->getDestTy()))) {
5440 CI->setPredicate(CI->getInversePredicate());
5441 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, CI, Op0C->getType());
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005442 }
5443 }
5444 }
5445 }
5446
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005447 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00005448 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005449 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
5450 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005451 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
5452 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005453 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005454 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005455 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005456
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005457 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005458 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00005459 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005460 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005461 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005462 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005463 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005464 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005465 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00005466 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005467 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005468 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
5469 RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005470 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00005471
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005472 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005473 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
5474 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00005475 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005476 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005477 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
5478 // NewRHS.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005479 Constant *CommonBits = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
5480 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
5481 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00005482 Worklist.Add(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005483 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
5484 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
5485 return &I;
5486 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00005487 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005488 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00005489 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005490
5491 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5492 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005493 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005494 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00005495 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5496 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5497 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005498 }
5499
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005500 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005501 if (X == Op1)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005502 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005503
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005504 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005505 if (X == Op0)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005506 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005507
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005508
5509 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
5510 if (Op1I) {
5511 Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005512 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005513 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005514 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005515 I.swapOperands();
5516 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005517 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005518 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005519 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005520 }
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005521 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005522 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // A^(A^B) == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005523 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op0)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005524 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // A^(B^A) == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005525 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005526 Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005527 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005528 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005529 std::swap(A, B);
5530 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005531 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005532 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
5533 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
5534 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00005535 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005536 }
5537
5538 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5539 if (Op0I) {
5540 Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005541 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005542 Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005543 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
5544 std::swap(A, B);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005545 if (B == Op1) // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
5546 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"));
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005547 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005548 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // (A^B)^A == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005549 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op1)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // (B^A)^A == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005551 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005552 Op0I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005553 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
5554 std::swap(A, B);
5555 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00005556 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005557 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Builder->CreateNot(A, "tmp"), Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005558 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005559 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005560 }
5561
5562 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
5563 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
5564 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
5565 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5566 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005567 Value *NewOp =
5568 Builder->CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1I->getOperand(0),
5569 Op0I->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005570 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005571 Op1I->getOperand(1));
5572 }
5573
5574 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
5575 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5576 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005577 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5578 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005579 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005580 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005581 }
5582 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005583 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5584 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005585 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005586 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005587 }
5588
5589 // (A & B)^(C & D)
5590 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005591 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5592 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005593 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
5594 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5595 if (A == C)
5596 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
5597 else if (A == D)
5598 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
5599 else if (B == C)
5600 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
5601 else if (B == D)
5602 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
5603
5604 if (X) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005605 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005606 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005607 }
5608 }
5609 }
5610
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005611 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
5612 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005613 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00005614 return R;
5615
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005616 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005617 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005618 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005619 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
5620 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005621 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005622 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005623 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5624 I.getType(), TD) &&
5625 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5626 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005627 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
5628 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005629 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005630 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005631 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005632 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005633
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005634 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005635}
5636
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005637static ConstantInt *ExtractElement(Constant *V, Constant *Idx,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005638 LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005639 return cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getExtractElement(V, Idx));
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005640}
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005641
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005642static bool HasAddOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5643 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5644 bool IsSigned) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005645 if (IsSigned)
5646 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5647 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5648 else
5649 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5650 else
5651 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005652}
5653
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005654/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005655/// overflowed for this type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005656static bool AddWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005657 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005658 bool IsSigned = false) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005659 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005660
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005661 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5662 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005663 Constant *Idx = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005664 if (HasAddOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5665 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5666 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005667 IsSigned))
5668 return true;
5669 }
5670 return false;
5671 }
5672
5673 return HasAddOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5674 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5675 IsSigned);
5676}
5677
5678static bool HasSubOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5679 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5680 bool IsSigned) {
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005681 if (IsSigned)
5682 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5683 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5684 else
5685 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5686 else
5687 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5688}
5689
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005690/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
5691/// overflowed for this type.
5692static bool SubWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005693 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005694 bool IsSigned = false) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005695 Result = ConstantExpr::getSub(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005696
5697 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5698 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005699 Constant *Idx = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005700 if (HasSubOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5701 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5702 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005703 IsSigned))
5704 return true;
5705 }
5706 return false;
5707 }
5708
5709 return HasSubOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5710 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5711 IsSigned);
5712}
5713
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005714
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005715/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005716/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005717Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(GEPOperator *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005718 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5719 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005720 // Look through bitcasts.
5721 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5722 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005723
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005724 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005725 if (TD && PtrBase == RHS && GEPLHS->isInBounds()) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005726 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005727 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005728 // know pointers can't overflow since the gep is inbounds. See if we can
5729 // output an optimized form.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005730 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5731
5732 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5733 if (Offset == 0)
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00005734 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, *this);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005735 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005736 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005737 } else if (GEPOperator *GEPRHS = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005738 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5739 // compare the base pointer.
5740 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5741 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005742 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005743 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005744 if (IndicesTheSame)
5745 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5746 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5747 IndicesTheSame = false;
5748 break;
5749 }
5750
5751 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5752 if (IndicesTheSame)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005753 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005754 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005755
5756 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5757 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005758 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005759 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005760
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005761 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5762 bool AllZeros = true;
5763 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5764 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5765 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5766 AllZeros = false;
5767 break;
5768 }
5769 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005770 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5771 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005772
5773 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005774 AllZeros = true;
5775 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5776 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5777 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5778 AllZeros = false;
5779 break;
5780 }
5781 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005782 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005783
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005784 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5785 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5786 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5787 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5788 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5789 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005790 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5791 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005792 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005793 NumDifferences = 2;
5794 break;
5795 } else {
5796 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5797 DiffOperand = i;
5798 }
5799 }
5800
5801 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005803 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005804 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005805
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005806 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005807 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5808 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005809 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005810 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005811 }
5812 }
5813
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005814 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005815 // the result to fold to a constant!
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005816 if (TD &&
5817 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005818 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5819 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00005820 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, *this);
5821 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, *this);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005822 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005823 }
5824 }
5825 return 0;
5826}
5827
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005828/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5829///
5830Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5831 Instruction *LHSI,
5832 Constant *RHSC) {
5833 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5834 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5835
5836 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5837 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005838 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005839 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5840
5841 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5842 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5843 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005844 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005845
5846 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005847 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5848 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005849 ++InputSize;
5850
5851 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5852 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5853 return 0;
5854
5855 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5856 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5857 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5858 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5859
5860 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5861 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005862 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected predicate!");
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005863 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005864 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5865 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5866 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005867 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005868 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5869 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5870 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005871 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005872 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5873 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5874 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005875 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005876 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5877 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5878 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005879 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005880 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5881 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5882 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005883 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005884 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5885 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5886 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005887 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005888 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005889 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005890 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005891 }
5892
5893 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5894
5895 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5896
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005897 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005898 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005899 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005900
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005901 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5902 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5903 // and large values.
5904 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5905 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5906 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5907 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5908 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5909 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5911 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005912 }
5913 } else {
5914 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5915 // +INF and large values.
5916 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5917 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5918 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5919 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5920 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5921 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005922 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5923 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005924 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005925 }
5926
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005927 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5928 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5929 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5930 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5931 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5932 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5933 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5934 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005935 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5936 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005937 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005938 }
5939
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005940 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5941 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5942 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5943 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005944 Constant *RHSInt = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005945 ? ConstantExpr::getFPToUI(RHSC, IntTy)
5946 : ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005947 if (!RHS.isZero()) {
5948 bool Equal = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005949 ? ConstantExpr::getUIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC
5950 : ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC;
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005951 if (!Equal) {
5952 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5953 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5954 // zero at this point.
5955 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005956 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer comparison!");
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005957 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005958 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005959 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005960 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005961 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5962 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5963 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5964 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005965 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005966 break;
5967 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5968 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5969 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5970 if (RHS.isNegative())
5971 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5972 break;
5973 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5974 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5975 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5976 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005977 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005978 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5979 break;
5980 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5981 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5982 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5983 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5984 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5985 break;
5986 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5987 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5988 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5989 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005991 break;
5992 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5993 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5994 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5995 if (RHS.isNegative())
5996 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5997 break;
5998 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5999 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
6000 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
6001 if (!RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006002 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00006003 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
6004 break;
6005 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6006 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
6007 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
6008 if (!RHS.isNegative())
6009 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6010 break;
6011 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00006012 }
6013 }
6014
6015 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
6016 // comparison.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006017 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00006018}
6019
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006020
6021/// FoldCmpLoadFromIndexedGlobal - Called we see this pattern:
6022/// cmp pred (load (gep GV, ...)), cmpcst
6023/// where GV is a global variable with a constant initializer. Try to simplify
6024/// this into one or two simpler comparisons that do not need the load. For
6025/// example, we can optimize "icmp eq (load (gep "foo", 0, i)), 0" into
6026/// "icmp eq i, 3". We assume that eliminating a load is always goodness.
6027Instruction *InstCombiner::
6028FoldCmpLoadFromIndexedGlobal(GetElementPtrInst *GEP, GlobalVariable *GV,
6029 CmpInst &ICI) {
6030
6031 // There are many forms of this optimization we can handle, for now, just do
6032 // the simple index into a single-dimensional array.
6033 //
6034 // Require: GEP GV, 0, i
6035 if (GEP->getNumOperands() != 3 ||
6036 !isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(1)) ||
6037 !cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(1))->isZero())
6038 return 0;
6039
6040 ConstantArray *Init = dyn_cast<ConstantArray>(GV->getInitializer());
6041 if (Init == 0 || Init->getNumOperands() > 1024) return 0;
6042
6043
6044 // Variables for our state machines.
6045
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006046 // FirstTrueElement/SecondTrueElement - Used to emit a comparison of the form
6047 // "i == 47 | i == 87", where 47 is the first index the condition is true for,
6048 // and 87 is the second (and last) index. FirstTrueElement is -1 when
6049 // undefined, otherwise set to the first true element. SecondTrueElement is
6050 // -1 when undefined, -2 when overdefined and >= 0 when that index is true.
6051 int FirstTrueElement = -1, SecondTrueElement = -1;
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006052
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006053 // FirstFalseElement/SecondFalseElement - Used to emit a comparison of the
6054 // form "i != 47 & i != 87". Same state transitions as for true elements.
6055 int FirstFalseElement = -1, SecondFalseElement = -1;
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006056
Chris Lattner10d514e2010-01-02 08:56:52 +00006057 // MagicBitvector - This is a magic bitvector where we set a bit if the
6058 // comparison is true for element 'i'. If there are 64 elements or less in
6059 // the array, this will fully represent all the comparison results.
6060 uint64_t MagicBitvector = 0;
6061
6062
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006063 // Scan the array and see if one of our patterns matches.
6064 Constant *CompareRHS = cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6065 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Init->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
6066 // Find out if the comparison would be true or false for the i'th element.
6067 Constant *C = ConstantFoldCompareInstOperands(ICI.getPredicate(),
6068 Init->getOperand(i),
6069 CompareRHS, TD);
6070 // If the result is undef for this element, ignore it.
6071 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) continue;
6072
6073 // If we can't compute the result for any of the elements, we have to give
6074 // up evaluating the entire conditional.
6075 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(C)) return 0;
6076
6077 // Otherwise, we know if the comparison is true or false for this element,
6078 // update our state machines.
6079 bool IsTrueForElt = !cast<ConstantInt>(C)->isZero();
6080
6081 // State machine for single index comparison.
6082 if (IsTrueForElt) {
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006083 // Update the TrueElement state machine.
6084 if (FirstTrueElement == -1)
6085 FirstTrueElement = i;
6086 else if (SecondTrueElement == -1)
6087 SecondTrueElement = i;
6088 else
6089 SecondTrueElement = -2;
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006090 } else {
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006091 // Update the FalseElement state machine.
6092 if (FirstFalseElement == -1)
6093 FirstFalseElement = i;
6094 else if (SecondFalseElement == -1)
6095 SecondFalseElement = i;
6096 else
6097 SecondFalseElement = -2;
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006098 }
6099
Chris Lattner10d514e2010-01-02 08:56:52 +00006100 // If this element is in range, update our magic bitvector.
6101 if (i < 64 && IsTrueForElt)
Chris Lattner33a1ec72010-01-02 09:22:13 +00006102 MagicBitvector |= 1ULL << i;
Chris Lattner10d514e2010-01-02 08:56:52 +00006103
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006104 // If all of our states become overdefined, bail out early.
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006105 if (i >= 64 && SecondTrueElement == -2 && SecondFalseElement == -2)
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006106 return 0;
6107 }
6108
6109 // Now that we've scanned the entire array, emit our new comparison(s). We
6110 // order the state machines in complexity of the generated code.
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006111 Value *Idx = GEP->getOperand(2);
6112
6113 // If the comparison is only true for one or two elements, emit direct
6114 // comparisons.
6115 if (SecondTrueElement != -2) {
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006116 // None true -> false.
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006117 if (FirstTrueElement == -1)
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006118 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
6119
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006120 Value *FirstTrueIdx = ConstantInt::get(Idx->getType(), FirstTrueElement);
6121
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006122 // True for one element -> 'i == 47'.
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006123 if (SecondTrueElement == -1)
6124 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Idx, FirstTrueIdx);
6125
6126 // True for two elements -> 'i == 47 | i == 72'.
6127 Value *C1 = Builder->CreateICmpEQ(Idx, FirstTrueIdx);
6128 Value *SecondTrueIdx = ConstantInt::get(Idx->getType(), SecondTrueElement);
6129 Value *C2 = Builder->CreateICmpEQ(Idx, SecondTrueIdx);
6130 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(C1, C2);
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006131 }
6132
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006133 // If the comparison is only false for one or two elements, emit direct
6134 // comparisons.
6135 if (SecondFalseElement != -2) {
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006136 // None false -> true.
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006137 if (FirstFalseElement == -1)
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006138 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
6139
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006140 Value *FirstFalseIdx = ConstantInt::get(Idx->getType(), FirstFalseElement);
6141
6142 // False for one element -> 'i != 47'.
6143 if (SecondFalseElement == -1)
6144 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Idx, FirstFalseIdx);
6145
6146 // False for two elements -> 'i != 47 & i != 72'.
6147 Value *C1 = Builder->CreateICmpNE(Idx, FirstFalseIdx);
6148 Value *SecondFalseIdx = ConstantInt::get(Idx->getType(),SecondFalseElement);
6149 Value *C2 = Builder->CreateICmpNE(Idx, SecondFalseIdx);
6150 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(C1, C2);
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006151 }
6152
Chris Lattner10d514e2010-01-02 08:56:52 +00006153 // If a 32-bit or 64-bit magic bitvector captures the entire comparison state
6154 // of this load, replace it with computation that does:
6155 // ((magic_cst >> i) & 1) != 0
6156 if (Init->getNumOperands() <= 32 ||
6157 (TD && Init->getNumOperands() <= 64 && TD->isLegalInteger(64))) {
6158 const Type *Ty;
6159 if (Init->getNumOperands() <= 32)
6160 Ty = Type::getInt32Ty(Init->getContext());
6161 else
6162 Ty = Type::getInt64Ty(Init->getContext());
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006163 Value *V = Builder->CreateIntCast(Idx, Ty, false);
Chris Lattner10d514e2010-01-02 08:56:52 +00006164 V = Builder->CreateLShr(ConstantInt::get(Ty, MagicBitvector), V);
6165 V = Builder->CreateAnd(ConstantInt::get(Ty, 1), V);
6166 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, ConstantInt::get(Ty, 0));
6167 }
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006168
Chris Lattnerbef37372010-01-02 09:35:17 +00006169 // TODO: Range check
6170 // TODO: GEP 0, i, 4
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006171 return 0;
6172}
6173
6174
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006175Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
Chris Lattnerb0bdac02009-11-09 23:31:49 +00006176 bool Changed = false;
6177
6178 /// Orders the operands of the compare so that they are listed from most
6179 /// complex to least complex. This puts constants before unary operators,
6180 /// before binary operators.
6181 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1))) {
6182 I.swapOperands();
6183 Changed = true;
6184 }
6185
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006186 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00006187
Chris Lattner210c5d42009-11-09 23:55:12 +00006188 if (Value *V = SimplifyFCmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1, TD))
6189 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, V);
6190
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00006191 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
6192 if (Op0 == Op1) {
6193 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006194 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown predicate!");
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00006195 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
6196 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
6197 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
6198 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
6199 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
6200 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006201 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00006202 return &I;
6203
6204 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
6205 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
6206 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
6207 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
6208 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
6209 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006210 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00006211 return &I;
6212 }
6213 }
6214
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006215 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
6216 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
6217 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
6218 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
6219 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006220 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
6221 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
6222 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
6223 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006224 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I, true))
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006225 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006226 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00006227 case Instruction::SIToFP:
6228 case Instruction::UIToFP:
6229 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
6230 return NV;
6231 break;
Chris Lattner34e0c762010-01-02 08:20:51 +00006232 case Instruction::Select: {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006233 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
6234 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
6235 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
6236 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
6237 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6238 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6239 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006240 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006241 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006242 Op2 = Builder->CreateFCmp(I.getPredicate(),
6243 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC, I.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006244 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
6245 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006246 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006247 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006248 Op1 = Builder->CreateFCmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(1),
6249 RHSC, I.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006250 }
6251 }
6252
6253 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00006254 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006255 break;
6256 }
Chris Lattner34e0c762010-01-02 08:20:51 +00006257 case Instruction::Load:
6258 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
6259 dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6260 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
6261 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer() &&
6262 !cast<LoadInst>(LHSI)->isVolatile())
6263 if (Instruction *Res = FoldCmpLoadFromIndexedGlobal(GEP, GV, I))
6264 return Res;
6265 //errs() << "NOT HANDLED: " << *GV << "\n";
6266 //errs() << "\t" << *GEP << "\n";
6267 //errs() << "\t " << I << "\n\n\n";
6268 }
6269 break;
6270 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006271 }
6272
6273 return Changed ? &I : 0;
6274}
6275
6276Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
Chris Lattnerb0bdac02009-11-09 23:31:49 +00006277 bool Changed = false;
6278
6279 /// Orders the operands of the compare so that they are listed from most
6280 /// complex to least complex. This puts constants before unary operators,
6281 /// before binary operators.
6282 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1))) {
6283 I.swapOperands();
6284 Changed = true;
6285 }
6286
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006287 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00006288
Chris Lattner210c5d42009-11-09 23:55:12 +00006289 if (Value *V = SimplifyICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1, TD))
6290 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, V);
6291
6292 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006293
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006294 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00006295 if (Ty == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006296 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006297 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006298 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006299 Value *Xor = Builder->CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006300 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006301 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006302 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006303 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006304
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006305 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006306 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006307 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006308 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006309 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006310 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006311 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006312 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6313 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006314 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006315 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006316 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006317 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
6318 }
6319 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6320 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
6321 // FALL THROUGH
6322 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006323 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006324 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006325 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006326 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6327 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
6328 // FALL THROUGH
6329 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006330 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006331 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
6332 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006333 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006334 }
6335
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006336 unsigned BitWidth = 0;
6337 if (TD)
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00006338 BitWidth = TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty->getScalarType());
6339 else if (Ty->isIntOrIntVector())
6340 BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006341
6342 bool isSignBit = false;
6343
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006344 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006345 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky579214a2009-02-27 06:37:39 +00006346 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006347
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006348 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006349 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isZero() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006350 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006351 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006352 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00006353 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006354
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006355 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
6356 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
Chris Lattner210c5d42009-11-09 23:55:12 +00006357 // them being folded in the code below. The SimplifyICmpInst code has
6358 // already handled the edge cases for us, so we just assert on them.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006359 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
6360 default: break;
6361 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
Chris Lattner210c5d42009-11-09 23:55:12 +00006362 assert(!CI->isMaxValue(false)); // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006363 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006364 AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006365 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
Chris Lattner210c5d42009-11-09 23:55:12 +00006366 assert(!CI->isMaxValue(true)); // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006367 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006368 AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006369 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
Chris Lattner210c5d42009-11-09 23:55:12 +00006370 assert(!CI->isMinValue(false)); // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006371 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006372 SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006373 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
Chris Lattner210c5d42009-11-09 23:55:12 +00006374 assert(!CI->isMinValue(true)); // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006375 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006376 SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006377 }
6378
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006379 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006380 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006381 bool UnusedBit;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006382 isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
6383 }
6384
6385 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
6386 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
6387 if (BitWidth != 0) {
6388 APInt Op0KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op0KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6389 APInt Op1KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op1KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6390
6391 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(0),
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006392 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
6393 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006394 Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne, 0))
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006395 return &I;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006396 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(1),
6397 APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
6398 Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne, 0))
6399 return &I;
6400
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006401 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006402 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
6403 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006404 APInt Op0Min(BitWidth, 0), Op0Max(BitWidth, 0);
6405 APInt Op1Min(BitWidth, 0), Op1Max(BitWidth, 0);
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00006406 if (I.isSigned()) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006407 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6408 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6409 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6410 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6411 } else {
6412 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6413 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6414 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6415 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6416 }
6417
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006418 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
6419 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
6420 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006421 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0) && Op0Min == Op0Max)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006422 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006423 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Op0Min), Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006424 if (!isa<Constant>(Op1) && Op1Min == Op1Max)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006425 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006426 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Op1Min));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006427
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006428 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
6429 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006430 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006431 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006432 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006433 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006434 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006435 break;
6436 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006437 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006438 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006439 break;
6440 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006441 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A <u B -> true if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006443 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A <u B -> false if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006444 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006445 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <u B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006446 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006447 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6448 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <u C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006449 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006450 SubOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006451
6452 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
6453 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006454 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006455 Constant::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006456 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006457 break;
6458 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006459 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A >u B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006460 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006461 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A >u B -> false if max(A) <= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006463
6464 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >u B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006465 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006466 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6467 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >u C -> A == C+1 if max(a)-1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006468 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006469 AddOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006470
6471 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
6472 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006473 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006474 Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006475 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006476 break;
6477 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006478 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A <s B -> true if max(A) < min(C)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006479 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006480 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A <s B -> false if min(A) >= max(C)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006481 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006482 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <s B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006483 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006484 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6485 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <s C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006486 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006487 SubOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006488 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006489 break;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6491 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A >s B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006492 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006493 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A >s B -> false if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006494 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006495
6496 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >s B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006497 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006498 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6499 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >s C -> A == C+1 if max(A)-1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006500 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006501 AddOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006502 }
6503 break;
6504 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6505 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6506 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A >=s B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006507 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006508 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A >=s B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006509 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006510 break;
6511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6512 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SLE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6513 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A <=s B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006514 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006515 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A <=s B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006516 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006517 break;
6518 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6519 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_UGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6520 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A >=u B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006521 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006522 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A >=u B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006523 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006524 break;
6525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6526 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_ULE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6527 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A <=u B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006529 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A <=u B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006530 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006531 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006532 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006533
6534 // Turn a signed comparison into an unsigned one if both operands
6535 // are known to have the same sign.
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00006536 if (I.isSigned() &&
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006537 ((Op0KnownZero.isNegative() && Op1KnownZero.isNegative()) ||
6538 (Op0KnownOne.isNegative() && Op1KnownOne.isNegative())))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006539 return new ICmpInst(I.getUnsignedPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006540 }
6541
6542 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
6543 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
6544 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
6545 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
6546 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
6547 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
6548 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
6549 if (I.hasOneUse())
6550 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
6551 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
6552 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
6553 return 0;
6554
6555 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
6556 // can be folded into the comparison.
6557 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006558 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00006559 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006560 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00006561 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006562 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
6563 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006564 }
6565
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006566 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006567 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
6568 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
6569 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006570 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006571 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattnerec12d052010-01-01 23:09:08 +00006572 if (RHSC->isNullValue() &&
6573 cast<GetElementPtrInst>(LHSI)->hasAllZeroIndices())
6574 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6575 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006576 break;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006577 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006578 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and icmp are in the same
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006579 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
6580 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
6581 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006582 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I, true))
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006583 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006584 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006585 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006586 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
6587 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
6588 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
6589 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
Eli Friedman97b087c2009-12-18 08:22:35 +00006590 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6591 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
6592 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2)))
6593 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
6594
6595 // We only want to perform this transformation if it will not lead to
6596 // additional code. This is true if either both sides of the select
6597 // fold to a constant (in which case the icmp is replaced with a select
6598 // which will usually simplify) or this is the only user of the
6599 // select (in which case we are trading a select+icmp for a simpler
6600 // select+icmp).
6601 if ((Op1 && Op2) || (LHSI->hasOneUse() && (Op1 || Op2))) {
6602 if (!Op1)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006603 Op1 = Builder->CreateICmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(1),
6604 RHSC, I.getName());
Eli Friedman97b087c2009-12-18 08:22:35 +00006605 if (!Op2)
6606 Op2 = Builder->CreateICmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(2),
6607 RHSC, I.getName());
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00006608 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Eli Friedman97b087c2009-12-18 08:22:35 +00006609 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006610 break;
6611 }
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00006612 case Instruction::Call:
6613 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6614 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6615 if (isMalloc(LHSI) && LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6616 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
Victor Hernandez68afa542009-10-21 19:11:40 +00006617 // Need to explicitly erase malloc call here, instead of adding it to
6618 // Worklist, because it won't get DCE'd from the Worklist since
6619 // isInstructionTriviallyDead() returns false for function calls.
6620 // It is OK to replace LHSI/MallocCall with Undef because the
6621 // instruction that uses it will be erased via Worklist.
6622 if (extractMallocCall(LHSI)) {
6623 LHSI->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(LHSI->getType()));
6624 EraseInstFromFunction(*LHSI);
6625 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00006626 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
6627 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Victor Hernandez68afa542009-10-21 19:11:40 +00006628 }
6629 if (CallInst* MallocCall = extractMallocCallFromBitCast(LHSI))
6630 if (MallocCall->hasOneUse()) {
6631 MallocCall->replaceAllUsesWith(
6632 UndefValue::get(MallocCall->getType()));
6633 EraseInstFromFunction(*MallocCall);
6634 Worklist.Add(LHSI); // The malloc's bitcast use.
6635 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
6636 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
6637 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
6638 }
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00006639 }
6640 break;
Chris Lattnerec12d052010-01-01 23:09:08 +00006641 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
6642 // icmp pred inttoptr(X), null -> icmp pred X, 0
6643 if (RHSC->isNullValue() && TD &&
6644 TD->getIntPtrType(RHSC->getContext()) ==
6645 LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType())
6646 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6647 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
6648 break;
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006649
6650 case Instruction::Load:
6651 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Chris Lattner34e0c762010-01-02 08:20:51 +00006652 dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006653 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
6654 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer() &&
Chris Lattner34e0c762010-01-02 08:20:51 +00006655 !cast<LoadInst>(LHSI)->isVolatile())
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006656 if (Instruction *Res = FoldCmpLoadFromIndexedGlobal(GEP, GV, I))
6657 return Res;
Chris Lattner34e0c762010-01-02 08:20:51 +00006658 //errs() << "NOT HANDLED: " << *GV << "\n";
6659 //errs() << "\t" << *GEP << "\n";
6660 //errs() << "\t " << I << "\n\n\n";
6661 }
Chris Lattner1f12e442010-01-02 08:12:04 +00006662 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006663 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006664 }
6665
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006666 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00006667 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006668 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006669 return NI;
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00006670 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006671 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
6672 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006673 return NI;
6674
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006675 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006676 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
6677 // now.
6678 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
6679 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
6680 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006681 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
6682 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006683 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006684
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006685 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
6686 // so eliminate it as well.
6687 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
6688 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006689
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006690 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006691 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006692 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006693 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006694 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006695 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00006696 Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(Op1, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006697 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006698 }
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006699 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006700 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006701 }
6702
6703 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006704 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006705 // This comes up when you have code like
6706 // int X = A < B;
6707 // if (X) ...
6708 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006709 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
Eli Friedman8e4b1972009-12-17 21:27:47 +00006710 if (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006711 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006712 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006713 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006714
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006715 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
6716 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6717 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006718 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006719 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1)) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00006720 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006721 default: break;
6722 case Instruction::Add:
6723 case Instruction::Sub:
6724 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006725 if (I.isEquality()) // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006726 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006727 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006728 // icmp u/s (a ^ signbit), (b ^ signbit) --> icmp s/u a, b
6729 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6730 if (CI->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00006731 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSigned()
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006732 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6733 : I.getSignedPredicate();
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006734 return new ICmpInst(Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006735 Op1I->getOperand(0));
6736 }
6737
6738 if (CI->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00006739 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSigned()
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006740 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6741 : I.getSignedPredicate();
6742 Pred = I.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006743 return new ICmpInst(Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006744 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006745 }
6746 }
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006747 break;
6748 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006749 if (!I.isEquality())
6750 break;
6751
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006752 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6753 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
6754 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
6755 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
6756 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006757 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006758 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
6759 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006760 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006761 Value *And1 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0), Mask);
6762 Value *And2 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0), Mask);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006763 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006764 }
6765 }
6766 break;
6767 }
6768 }
6769 }
6770 }
6771
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006772 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
6773 { Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006774 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
6775 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006776 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006777 }
6778
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006779 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006780 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006781
6782 // -x == -y --> x == y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006783 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
6784 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006785 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006786
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006787 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006788 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6789 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006790 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006791 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006792 }
6793
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006794 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006795 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006796 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006797 if (match(B, m_ConstantInt(C1)) &&
6798 match(D, m_ConstantInt(C2)) && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006799 Constant *NC =
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006800 ConstantInt::get(*Context, C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006801 Value *Xor = Builder->CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
6802 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, Xor);
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006803 }
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006804
6805 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006806 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6807 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6808 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6809 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006810 }
6811 }
6812
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006813 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006814 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006815 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6816 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006817 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006818 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006819 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006820
6821 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006822 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006823 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006824 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006825
6826 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006827 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006828 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006829 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006830
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006831 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6832 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006833 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6834 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006835 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6836
6837 if (A == C) {
6838 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6839 } else if (A == D) {
6840 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6841 } else if (B == C) {
6842 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6843 } else if (B == D) {
6844 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6845 }
6846
6847 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006848 Op1 = Builder->CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp");
6849 Op1 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006850 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006851 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006852 return &I;
6853 }
6854 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006855 }
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006856
6857 {
6858 Value *X; ConstantInt *Cst;
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006859 // icmp X+Cst, X
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006860 if (match(Op0, m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst))) && Op1 == X)
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006861 return FoldICmpAddOpCst(I, X, Cst, I.getPredicate(), Op0);
6862
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006863 // icmp X, X+Cst
6864 if (match(Op1, m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst))) && Op0 == X)
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006865 return FoldICmpAddOpCst(I, X, Cst, I.getSwappedPredicate(), Op1);
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006866 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006867 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006868}
6869
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006870/// FoldICmpAddOpCst - Fold "icmp pred (X+CI), X".
6871Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpAddOpCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6872 Value *X, ConstantInt *CI,
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006873 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred,
6874 Value *TheAdd) {
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006875 // If we have X+0, exit early (simplifying logic below) and let it get folded
6876 // elsewhere. icmp X+0, X -> icmp X, X
6877 if (CI->isZero()) {
6878 bool isTrue = ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred);
6879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(ICI.getType(), isTrue));
6880 }
6881
6882 // (X+4) == X -> false.
6883 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(X->getContext()));
6885
6886 // (X+4) != X -> true.
6887 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6888 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(X->getContext()));
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006889
6890 // If this is an instruction (as opposed to constantexpr) get NUW/NSW info.
6891 bool isNUW = false, isNSW = false;
6892 if (BinaryOperator *Add = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TheAdd)) {
6893 isNUW = Add->hasNoUnsignedWrap();
6894 isNSW = Add->hasNoSignedWrap();
6895 }
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006896
6897 // From this point on, we know that (X+C <= X) --> (X+C < X) because C != 0,
6898 // so the values can never be equal. Similiarly for all other "or equals"
6899 // operators.
6900
6901 // (X+1) <u X --> X >u (MAXUINT-1) --> X != 255
6902 // (X+2) <u X --> X >u (MAXUINT-2) --> X > 253
6903 // (X+MAXUINT) <u X --> X >u (MAXUINT-MAXUINT) --> X != 0
6904 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE) {
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006905 // If this is an NUW add, then this is always false.
6906 if (isNUW)
6907 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(X->getContext()));
6908
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006909 Value *R = ConstantExpr::getSub(ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), -1ULL), CI);
6910 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, X, R);
6911 }
6912
6913 // (X+1) >u X --> X <u (0-1) --> X != 255
6914 // (X+2) >u X --> X <u (0-2) --> X <u 254
6915 // (X+MAXUINT) >u X --> X <u (0-MAXUINT) --> X <u 1 --> X == 0
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006916 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE) {
6917 // If this is an NUW add, then this is always true.
6918 if (isNUW)
6919 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(X->getContext()));
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006920 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, ConstantExpr::getNeg(CI));
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006921 }
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006922
6923 unsigned BitWidth = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6924 ConstantInt *SMax = ConstantInt::get(X->getContext(),
6925 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth));
6926
6927 // (X+ 1) <s X --> X >s (MAXSINT-1) --> X == 127
6928 // (X+ 2) <s X --> X >s (MAXSINT-2) --> X >s 125
6929 // (X+MAXSINT) <s X --> X >s (MAXSINT-MAXSINT) --> X >s 0
6930 // (X+MINSINT) <s X --> X >s (MAXSINT-MINSINT) --> X >s -1
6931 // (X+ -2) <s X --> X >s (MAXSINT- -2) --> X >s 126
6932 // (X+ -1) <s X --> X >s (MAXSINT- -1) --> X != 127
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006933 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
6934 // If this is an NSW add, then we have two cases: if the constant is
6935 // positive, then this is always false, if negative, this is always true.
6936 if (isNSW) {
6937 bool isTrue = CI->getValue().isNegative();
6938 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(ICI.getType(), isTrue));
6939 }
6940
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006941 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, X, ConstantExpr::getSub(SMax, CI));
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006942 }
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006943
6944 // (X+ 1) >s X --> X <s (MAXSINT-(1-1)) --> X != 127
6945 // (X+ 2) >s X --> X <s (MAXSINT-(2-1)) --> X <s 126
6946 // (X+MAXSINT) >s X --> X <s (MAXSINT-(MAXSINT-1)) --> X <s 1
6947 // (X+MINSINT) >s X --> X <s (MAXSINT-(MINSINT-1)) --> X <s -2
6948 // (X+ -2) >s X --> X <s (MAXSINT-(-2-1)) --> X <s -126
6949 // (X+ -1) >s X --> X <s (MAXSINT-(-1-1)) --> X == -128
Chris Lattner3bf68152009-12-21 04:04:05 +00006950
6951 // If this is an NSW add, then we have two cases: if the constant is
6952 // positive, then this is always true, if negative, this is always false.
6953 if (isNSW) {
6954 bool isTrue = !CI->getValue().isNegative();
6955 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(ICI.getType(), isTrue));
6956 }
6957
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00006958 assert(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE);
6959 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(X->getContext(), CI->getValue()-1);
6960 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, X, ConstantExpr::getSub(SMax, C));
6961}
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006962
6963/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6964/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6965Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6966 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6967 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6968 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6969
6970 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6971 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6972 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6973 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6974 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6975 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6976 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6977 // if it finds it.
6978 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00006979 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSigned())
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006980 return 0;
6981 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006982 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006983 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6984 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6985 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6986 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6987 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006988
6989 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6990 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6991 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6992 // instead of computing a divide.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006993 Constant *Prod = ConstantExpr::getMul(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006994
6995 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6996 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6997 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006998 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6999 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007000
7001 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007002 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007003
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007004 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
7005 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
7006 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
7007 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
7008 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
7009 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
7010 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
7011 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007012 Constant *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007013
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007014 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007015 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007016 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007017 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
7018 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007019 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, Context, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00007020 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007021 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007022 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007023 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007024 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00007025 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007026 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
7027 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
7028 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007029 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007030 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007031 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007032 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00007033 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
7034 if (!LoOverflow) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007035 ConstantInt* DivNeg =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007036 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007037 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg, Context,
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00007038 true) ? -1 : 0;
7039 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007040 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00007041 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007042 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007043 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007044 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007045 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007046 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
7047 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
7048 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
7049 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00007050 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007051 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007052 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007053 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007054 if (!LoOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007055 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound,
7056 DivRHS, Context, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007057 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00007058 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
7059 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00007060 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007061 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007062 }
7063
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007064 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
7065 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007066 }
7067
7068 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007069 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00007070 default: llvm_unreachable("Unhandled icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007071 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
7072 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007073 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007074 else if (HiOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007075 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007076 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
7077 else if (LoOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007078 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007079 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
7080 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007081 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007082 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
7083 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007084 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007085 else if (HiOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007086 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007087 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
7088 else if (LoOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007089 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007090 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
7091 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007092 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007093 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
7094 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007095 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007096 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007097 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007098 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007099 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007100 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
7101 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007102 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007103 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007104 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007105 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00007106 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007107 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007108 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007109 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007110 }
7111}
7112
7113
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007114/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
7115///
7116Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
7117 Instruction *LHSI,
7118 ConstantInt *RHS) {
7119 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
7120
7121 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00007122 case Instruction::Trunc:
7123 if (ICI.isEquality() && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
7124 // Simplify icmp eq (trunc x to i8), 42 -> icmp eq x, 42|highbits if all
7125 // of the high bits truncated out of x are known.
7126 unsigned DstBits = LHSI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(),
7127 SrcBits = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7128 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(SrcBits, SrcBits-DstBits));
7129 APInt KnownZero(SrcBits, 0), KnownOne(SrcBits, 0);
7130 ComputeMaskedBits(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7131
7132 // If all the high bits are known, we can do this xform.
7133 if ((KnownZero|KnownOne).countLeadingOnes() >= SrcBits-DstBits) {
7134 // Pull in the high bits from known-ones set.
7135 APInt NewRHS(RHS->getValue());
7136 NewRHS.zext(SrcBits);
7137 NewRHS |= KnownOne;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007138 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007139 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewRHS));
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00007140 }
7141 }
7142 break;
7143
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00007144 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007145 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
7146 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
7147 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00007148 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
7149 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007150 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
7151
7152 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
7153 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
7154 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
7155 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00007156 Worklist.Add(LHSI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007157 return &ICI;
7158 }
7159
7160 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
7161 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
7162
7163 // If so, the new one isn't.
7164 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
7165
7166 if (isTrueIfPositive)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007167 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007168 SubOne(RHS));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007169 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007170 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007171 AddOne(RHS));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007172 }
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00007173
7174 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
7175 // (icmp u/s (xor A SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u A, (xor C SignBit))
7176 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isSignBit()) {
7177 const APInt &SignBit = XorCST->getValue();
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00007178 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSigned()
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00007179 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
7180 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007181 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007182 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV ^ SignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00007183 }
7184
7185 // (icmp u/s (xor A ~SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u (xor C ~SignBit), A)
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00007186 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00007187 const APInt &NotSignBit = XorCST->getValue();
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00007188 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSigned()
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00007189 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
7190 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
7191 Pred = ICI.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007192 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007193 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV ^ NotSignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00007194 }
7195 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007196 }
7197 break;
7198 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
7199 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
7200 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
7201 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
7202
7203 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
7204 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
7205 // produced, eliminating a cast.
7206 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
7207 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
7208 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
7209 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
7210 // bit would not work.
7211 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00007212 (ICI.isEquality() ||
7213 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007214 uint32_t BitWidth =
7215 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
7216 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
7217 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
7218 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
7219 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007220 Value *NewAnd =
7221 Builder->CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007222 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewCST), LHSI->getName());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007223 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007224 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewCI));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007225 }
7226 }
7227
7228 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
7229 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
7230 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
7231 // access.
7232 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
7233 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
7234 Shift = 0;
7235
7236 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
7237 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
7238 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
7239 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
7240
7241 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
7242 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
7243 // rights, as they sign-extend.
7244 if (ShAmt) {
7245 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
7246 if (!CanFold) {
7247 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
7248 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
7249 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7250 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
7251
7252 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7253 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
7254 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
7255 CanFold = true;
7256 }
7257
7258 if (CanFold) {
7259 Constant *NewCst;
7260 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007261 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007262 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007263 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007264
7265 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
7266 // compared.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007267 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007268 NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007269 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
7270 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
7271 // result is always true or false now.
7272 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007274 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007275 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007276 } else {
7277 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
7278 Constant *NewAndCST;
7279 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007280 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007281 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007282 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007283 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
7284 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00007285 Worklist.Add(Shift); // Shift is dead.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007286 return &ICI;
7287 }
7288 }
7289 }
7290
7291 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
7292 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
7293 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
7294 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
Chris Lattnere8e49212009-03-25 00:28:58 +00007295 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
7296 !isa<Constant>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007297 // Compute C << Y.
7298 Value *NS;
7299 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007300 NS = Builder->CreateShl(AndCST, Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007301 } else {
7302 // Insert a logical shift.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007303 NS = Builder->CreateLShr(AndCST, Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007304 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007305
7306 // Compute X & (C << Y).
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007307 Value *NewAnd =
7308 Builder->CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007309
7310 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
7311 return &ICI;
7312 }
7313 }
7314 break;
7315
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007316 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
7317 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
7318 if (!ShAmt) break;
7319
7320 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
7321
7322 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
7323 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
7324 // simplified.
7325 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
7326 break;
7327
7328 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
7329 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
7330 // comparison cannot succeed.
7331 Constant *Comp =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007332 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007333 ShAmt);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007334 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
7335 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007336 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
7338 }
7339
7340 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
7341 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
7342 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7343 Constant *Mask =
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007344 ConstantInt::get(*Context, APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007345 TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007346
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007347 Value *And =
7348 Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007349 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007350 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007351 }
7352 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007353
7354 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
7355 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
7356 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
7357 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
7358 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007359 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context, APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007360 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007361 Value *And =
7362 Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007363 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007364 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007365 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007366 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007367 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007368
7369 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007370 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007371 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007372 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007373 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007374
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007375 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
7376 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
7377 // simplified.
7378 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
7379 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
7380 break;
7381
7382 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007383
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007384 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
7385 // comparison cannot succeed.
7386 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
7387 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
7388 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
7389 else
7390 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
7391
7392 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
7393 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007394 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
7396 }
7397
7398 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
7399 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
7400 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00007401 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
7402 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007403 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007404 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007405 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007406 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007407
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00007408 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007409 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
7410 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007411 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context, Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007412
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007413 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
7414 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007415 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007416 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007417 }
7418 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007419 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007420
7421 case Instruction::SDiv:
7422 case Instruction::UDiv:
7423 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
7424 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
7425 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
7426 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
7427 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
7428 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007429 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
7430 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
7431 DivRHS))
7432 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007433 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007434
7435 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner2799baf2009-12-21 03:19:28 +00007436 // Fold: icmp pred (add X, C1), C2
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007437 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
7438 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
7439 if (!LHSC) break;
7440 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
7441
7442 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
7443 .subtract(LHSV);
7444
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00007445 if (ICI.isSigned()) {
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007446 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007447 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007448 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007449 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007450 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007451 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007452 }
7453 } else {
7454 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007455 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007456 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007457 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007458 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007459 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007460 }
7461 }
7462 }
7463 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007464 }
7465
7466 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
7467 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
7468 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7469
7470 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
7471 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
7472 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
7473 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
7474 case Instruction::SRem:
7475 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
7476 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
7477 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
7478 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007479 Value *NewRem =
7480 Builder->CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
7481 BO->getName());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007482 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007483 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007484 }
7485 }
7486 break;
7487 case Instruction::Add:
7488 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
7489 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7490 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007491 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007492 ConstantExpr::getSub(RHS, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007493 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
7494 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
7495 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
7496 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
7497
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007498 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007499 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007500 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007501 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007502 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007503 Value *Neg = Builder->CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007504 Neg->takeName(BO);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007505 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007506 }
7507 }
7508 break;
7509 case Instruction::Xor:
7510 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
7511 // the explicit xor.
7512 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007513 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007514 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007515
7516 // FALLTHROUGH
7517 case Instruction::Sub:
7518 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
7519 if (RHSV == 0)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007520 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007521 BO->getOperand(1));
7522 break;
7523
7524 case Instruction::Or:
7525 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
7526 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
7527 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007528 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
7529 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007530 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007531 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007532 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007533 }
7534 break;
7535
7536 case Instruction::And:
7537 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7538 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
7539 // comparison can never succeed!
7540 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007541 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007542 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007543 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007544
7545 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
7546 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007547 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007548 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007549 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007550
7551 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00007552 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007553 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007554 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007555 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7556 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007557 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007558 }
7559
7560 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
7561 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
7562 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007563 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007564 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7565 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007566 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007567 }
7568 }
7569 default: break;
7570 }
7571 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
7572 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
7573 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00007574 Worklist.Add(II);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007575 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007576 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV.byteSwap()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007577 return &ICI;
7578 }
7579 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007580 }
7581 return 0;
7582}
7583
7584/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
7585/// We only handle extending casts so far.
7586///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007587Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
7588 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007589 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
7590 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007591 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007592 Value *RHSCIOp;
7593
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007594 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
7595 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007596 if (TD && LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
7597 TD->getPointerSizeInBits() ==
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007598 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
7599 Value *RHSOp = 0;
7600 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007601 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007602 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
7603 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
7604 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
7605 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00007606 RHSOp = Builder->CreateBitCast(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType());
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007607 }
7608
7609 if (RHSOp)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007610 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007611 }
7612
7613 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
7614 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007615 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
7616 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00007617 return 0;
7618
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007619 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
Nick Lewycky4a134af2009-10-25 05:20:17 +00007620 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSigned();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007621
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007622 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007623 // Not an extension from the same type?
7624 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007625 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
7626 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007627
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007628 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007629 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
7630 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
7631 return 0;
7632
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007633 // Deal with equality cases early.
7634 if (ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007635 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007636
7637 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
7638 // signed comparison.
7639 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007640 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007641
7642 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007643 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00007644 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007645
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007646 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
7647 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
7648 if (!CI)
7649 return 0;
7650
7651 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
7652 // reextended to DestTy.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007653 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
7654 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007655 Res1, DestTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007656
7657 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
7658 if (Res2 == CI) {
Eli Friedmanb17cb062009-12-17 22:42:29 +00007659 // Deal with equality cases early.
7660 if (ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007661 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Eli Friedmanb17cb062009-12-17 22:42:29 +00007662
7663 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
7664 // signed comparison.
7665 if (isSignedExt && isSignedCmp)
7666 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
7667
7668 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
7669 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007670 }
7671
7672 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
7673 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
7674
7675 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
7676 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
7677 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007679 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007680 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007681
7682 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
7683 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
7684 Value *Result;
7685 if (isSignedCmp) {
7686 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00007687 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007688 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007689 else
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007690 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007691 } else {
7692 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
7693 if (isSignedExt) {
7694 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
7695 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007696 Constant *NegOne = Constant::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007697 Result = Builder->CreateICmpSGT(LHSCIOp, NegOne, ICI.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007698 } else {
7699 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007700 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007701 }
7702 }
7703
7704 // Finally, return the value computed.
7705 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007706 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007707 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007708
7709 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
7710 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
7711 "ICmp should be folded!");
7712 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007713 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007714 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007715}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007716
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007717Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
7718 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7719}
7720
7721Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
7722 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7723}
7724
7725Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007726 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
7727 return R;
7728
7729 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
7730
7731 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
7732 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
7733 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
7734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007735
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007736 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
7737 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
7738 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())))
7739 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
7740
7741 // Arithmetic shifting an all-sign-bit value is a no-op.
7742 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op0);
7743 if (NumSignBits == Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())
7744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007745
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007746 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007747}
7748
7749Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
7750 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007751 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007752
7753 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
7754 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007755 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
7756 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00007757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007758
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007759 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
7760 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00007761 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007762 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007763 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007764 }
7765 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007766 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
7767 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
7768 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007770 }
7771
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007772 // See if we can fold away this shift.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007773 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007774 return &I;
7775
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007776 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7777 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
7778 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007779 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007780 return R;
7781
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007782 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007783 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
7784 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007785 return 0;
7786}
7787
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007788Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007789 BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +00007790 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007791
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007792 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
7793 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007794 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007795
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007796 // shl i32 X, 32 = 0 and srl i8 Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate
7797 // a signed shift.
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007798 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007799 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00007800 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007801 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007802 else {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007803 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007804 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00007805 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007806 }
7807
7808 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
7809 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
7810 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
7811 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007812 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007813 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007814
7815 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7816 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
7817 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
7818 return R;
7819 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
7820 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
7821 return NV;
7822
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007823 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
7824 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
7825 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
7826 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
7827 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
7828 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
7829 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
7830 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
7831 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
7832 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
7833 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007834 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007835 // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
7836 Value *NSh = Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,I.getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007837
7838 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
7839 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
7840 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
7841 // other xforms later if dead.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007842 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
7843 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007844 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
7845
7846 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
7847 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
7848 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
7849 // mask as appropriate.
7850 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
7851 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
7852 else {
7853 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
7854 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
7855 }
7856
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007857 // shift1 & 0x00FF
7858 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(*Context, MaskV),
7859 TI->getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007860
7861 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
7862 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
7863 }
7864 }
7865
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007866 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007867 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
7868 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
7869 Value *V1, *V2;
7870 ConstantInt *CC;
7871 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007872 default: break;
7873 case Instruction::Add:
7874 case Instruction::And:
7875 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007876 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007877 // These operators commute.
7878 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007879 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007880 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007881 m_Specific(Op1)))) {
7882 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7883 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7884 // (X + (Y << C))
7885 Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
7886 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007887 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007888 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007889 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007890 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007891
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007892 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007893 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00007894 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007895 match(Op0BOOp1,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007896 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007897 m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007898 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007899 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7900 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
7901 Op0BO->getName());
7902 // X & (CC << C)
7903 Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
7904 V1->getName()+".mask");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007905 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007906 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007907 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007908
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007909 // FALL THROUGH.
7910 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007911 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007912 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007913 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007914 m_Specific(Op1)))) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007915 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7916 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7917 // (X + (Y << C))
7918 Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
7919 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007920 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007921 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007922 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007923 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007924
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007925 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007926 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7927 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7928 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007929 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007930 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7931 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007932 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7933 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7934 // X & (CC << C)
7935 Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
7936 V1->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007937
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007938 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007939 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007940
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007941 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007942 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007943 }
7944
7945
7946 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7947 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7948 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7949 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7950 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7951
7952 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007953 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007954 case Instruction::Add:
7955 isValid = isLeftShift;
7956 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007957 case Instruction::Or:
7958 case Instruction::Xor:
7959 highBitSet = false;
7960 break;
7961 case Instruction::And:
7962 highBitSet = true;
7963 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007964 }
7965
7966 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7967 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7968 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7969 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7970 // operation.
7971 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007972 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007973 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007974
7975 if (isValid) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007976 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007977
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007978 Value *NewShift =
7979 Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007980 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007981
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007982 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007983 NewRHS);
7984 }
7985 }
7986 }
7987 }
7988
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007989 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007990 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7991 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7992 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007993
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007994 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007995 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007996 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7997 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007998 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7999 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
8000 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00008001
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008002 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008003
8004 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
8005
8006 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00008007 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00008008 // If this is oversized composite shift, then unsigned shifts get 0, ashr
8009 // saturates.
8010 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits) {
8011 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00008013 AmtSum = TypeBits-1; // Saturate to 31 for i32 ashr.
8014 }
8015
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008016 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008017 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008018 }
8019
8020 if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
8021 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00008022 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008023 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00008024
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008025 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008026 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008027 }
8028
8029 if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
8030 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008031 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00008032 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
8033 AmtSum = TypeBits-1;
8034
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008035 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008036
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00008037 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008038 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00008039 }
8040
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008041 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
8042 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
8043 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
8044 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
8045 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00008046 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008047 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008048 }
8049 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
8050 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00008051 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008052 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008053 }
8054 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
8055 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
8056 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
8057 // generators.
8058 const Type *SExtType = 0;
8059 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00008060 case 1 :
8061 case 8 :
8062 case 16 :
8063 case 32 :
8064 case 64 :
8065 case 128:
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008066 SExtType = IntegerType::get(*Context, Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00008067 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008068 default: break;
8069 }
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008070 if (SExtType)
8071 return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(X, SExtType, "sext"), Ty);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008072 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
8073 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008074 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00008075
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00008076 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008077 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
8078 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
8079 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008080 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00008081
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00008082 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008083 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
8084 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00008085 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008086
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00008087 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008088 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
8089 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008090 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00008091
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00008092 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008093 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
8094 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00008095 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008096
8097 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
8098 } else {
8099 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008100 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008101
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00008102 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008103 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
8104 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
8105 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008106 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateBinOp(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
8107 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008108
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00008109 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008110 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
8111 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008112 }
8113
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00008114 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008115 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
8116 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008117 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008118
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00008119 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008120 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
8121 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00008122 }
8123
8124 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008125 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00008126 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00008127 return 0;
8128}
8129
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008130
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00008131/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
8132/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
8133/// X*Scale+Offset.
8134///
8135static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008136 int &Offset, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008137 assert(Val->getType() == Type::getInt32Ty(*Context) &&
8138 "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008139 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008140 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008141 Scale = 0;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008142 return ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008143 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
8144 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
8145 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
8146 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
8147 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
8148 Offset = 0;
8149 return I->getOperand(0);
8150 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
8151 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
8152 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
8153 Offset = 0;
8154 return I->getOperand(0);
8155 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8156 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
8157 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
8158 unsigned SubScale;
8159 Value *SubVal =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008160 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale,
8161 Offset, Context);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008162 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
8163 Scale = SubScale;
8164 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00008165 }
8166 }
8167 }
8168
8169 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
8170 Scale = 1;
8171 Offset = 0;
8172 return Val;
8173}
8174
8175
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00008176/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
8177/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008178Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +00008179 AllocaInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008180 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00008181
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008182 BuilderTy AllocaBuilder(*Builder);
8183 AllocaBuilder.SetInsertPoint(AI.getParent(), &AI);
8184
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00008185 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
8186 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00008187
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00008188 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
8189 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
8190 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
8191 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
8192 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
8193
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00008194 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +00008195 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *User << '\n');
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00008196 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00008197 }
8198 }
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008199
8200 // This requires TargetData to get the alloca alignment and size information.
8201 if (!TD) return 0;
8202
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00008203 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
8204 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
8205 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
8206 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00008207
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00008208 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
8209 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00008210 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
8211
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00008212 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
8213 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00008214 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds. (A reference
8215 // from a dbg.declare doesn't count as a use for this purpose.)
8216 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && !hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI) &&
8217 CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00008218
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008219 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AllocElTy);
8220 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00008221 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00008222
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00008223 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
8224 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00008225 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
8226 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00008227 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008228 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale,
8229 ArrayOffset, Context);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00008230
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00008231 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
8232 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00008233 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
8234 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00008235
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00008236 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
8237 Value *Amt = 0;
8238 if (Scale == 1) {
8239 Amt = NumElements;
8240 } else {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008241 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Scale);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008242 // Insert before the alloca, not before the cast.
8243 Amt = AllocaBuilder.CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00008244 }
8245
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00008246 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008247 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Offset, true);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008248 Amt = AllocaBuilder.CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00008249 }
8250
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +00008251 AllocaInst *New = AllocaBuilder.CreateAlloca(CastElTy, Amt);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008252 New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008253 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00008254
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00008255 // If the allocation has one real use plus a dbg.declare, just remove the
8256 // declare.
8257 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI)) {
8258 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
8259 }
8260 // If the allocation has multiple real uses, insert a cast and change all
8261 // things that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it
8262 // will die soon.
8263 else if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008264 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
8265 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008266 Value *NewCast = AllocaBuilder.CreateBitCast(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00008267 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
8268 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00008269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
8270}
8271
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008272/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008273/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
8274/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
8275/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
8276/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
8277///
8278/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
8279/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008280///
8281/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
8282/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
8283/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
8284/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
8285/// efficiently truncated.
8286///
8287/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
8288/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
8289/// the final result.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008290bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008291 unsigned CastOpc,
8292 int &NumCastsRemoved){
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008293 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008294 if (isa<Constant>(V))
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008295 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008296
8297 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008298 if (!I) return false;
8299
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008300 const Type *OrigTy = V->getType();
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008301
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008302 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
8303 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
8304 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
8305 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
8306 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
8307 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
8308 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
8309 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008310 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008311 ++NumCastsRemoved;
8312 return true;
8313 }
8314 }
8315
8316 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
8317 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
8318 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
8319
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008320 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
8321 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008322 case Instruction::Add:
8323 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008324 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008325 case Instruction::And:
8326 case Instruction::Or:
8327 case Instruction::Xor:
8328 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008329 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008330 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008331 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008332 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008333
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00008334 case Instruction::UDiv:
8335 case Instruction::URem: {
8336 // UDiv and URem can be truncated if all the truncated bits are zero.
8337 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8338 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
8339 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth) {
8340 APInt Mask = APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth);
8341 if (MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0), Mask) &&
8342 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(1), Mask)) {
8343 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
8344 NumCastsRemoved) &&
8345 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
8346 NumCastsRemoved);
8347 }
8348 }
8349 break;
8350 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008351 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008352 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
8353 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
8354 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008355 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
8356 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00008357 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008358 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008359 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008360 }
8361 break;
8362 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008363 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
8364 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
8365 // already zeros.
8366 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008367 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8368 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00008369 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008370 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00008371 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
8372 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008373 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008374 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008375 }
8376 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008377 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008378 case Instruction::ZExt:
8379 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008380 case Instruction::Trunc:
8381 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00008382 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
8383 // of casts in the input.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008384 if (Opc == CastOpc)
8385 return true;
8386
8387 // sext (zext ty1), ty2 -> zext ty2
Evan Cheng661d9c32009-01-15 17:09:07 +00008388 if (CastOpc == Instruction::SExt && Opc == Instruction::ZExt)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008389 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008390 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008391 case Instruction::Select: {
8392 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
8393 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008394 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008395 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008396 NumCastsRemoved);
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008397 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008398 case Instruction::PHI: {
8399 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
8400 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
8401 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
8402 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008403 NumCastsRemoved))
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008404 return false;
8405 return true;
8406 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008407 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008408 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
8409 break;
8410 }
8411
8412 return false;
8413}
8414
8415/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
8416/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
8417/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008418Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008419 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008420 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +00008421 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008422
8423 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
8424 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00008425 Instruction *Res = 0;
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008426 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
8427 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008428 case Instruction::Add:
8429 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00008430 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008431 case Instruction::And:
8432 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008433 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008434 case Instruction::AShr:
8435 case Instruction::LShr:
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00008436 case Instruction::Shl:
8437 case Instruction::UDiv:
8438 case Instruction::URem: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008439 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008440 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008441 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)Opc, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008442 break;
8443 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008444 case Instruction::Trunc:
8445 case Instruction::ZExt:
8446 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008447 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008448 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
8449 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008450 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
8451 return I->getOperand(0);
8452
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008453 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +00008454 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008455 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008456 case Instruction::Select: {
8457 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
8458 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
8459 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
8460 break;
8461 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008462 case Instruction::PHI: {
8463 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
8464 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
8465 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8466 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
8467 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
8468 }
8469 Res = NPN;
8470 break;
8471 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008472 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008473 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008474 llvm_unreachable("Unreachable!");
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008475 break;
8476 }
8477
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008478 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008479 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
8480}
8481
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008482/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
8483Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00008484 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8485
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00008486 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008487 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008488 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008489 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
8490 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
8491 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
8492 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008493 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00008494 }
8495 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00008496
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008497 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008498 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
8499 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
8500 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008501
8502 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +00008503 if (isa<PHINode>(Src)) {
8504 // We don't do this if this would create a PHI node with an illegal type if
8505 // it is currently legal.
8506 if (!isa<IntegerType>(Src->getType()) ||
8507 !isa<IntegerType>(CI.getType()) ||
Chris Lattnerc22d4d12009-11-10 07:23:37 +00008508 ShouldChangeType(CI.getType(), Src->getType(), TD))
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +00008509 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
8510 return NV;
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +00008511 }
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008512
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008513 return 0;
8514}
8515
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008516/// FindElementAtOffset - Given a type and a constant offset, determine whether
8517/// or not there is a sequence of GEP indices into the type that will land us at
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008518/// the specified offset. If so, fill them into NewIndices and return the
8519/// resultant element type, otherwise return null.
8520static const Type *FindElementAtOffset(const Type *Ty, int64_t Offset,
8521 SmallVectorImpl<Value*> &NewIndices,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008522 const TargetData *TD,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008523 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008524 if (!TD) return 0;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008525 if (!Ty->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008526
8527 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
8528 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
8529 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008530 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType(*Context);
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008531 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008532 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(Ty)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008533 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
Chris Lattner31a69cb2009-01-11 20:41:36 +00008534 Offset -= FirstIdx*TySize;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008535
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008536 // Handle hosts where % returns negative instead of values [0..TySize).
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008537 if (Offset < 0) {
8538 --FirstIdx;
8539 Offset += TySize;
8540 assert(Offset >= 0);
8541 }
8542 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize && "Out of range offset");
8543 }
8544
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008545 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008546
8547 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
8548 while (Offset) {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008549 // Indexing into tail padding between struct/array elements.
8550 if (uint64_t(Offset*8) >= TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008551 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008552
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008553 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) {
8554 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008555 assert(Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes() &&
8556 "Offset must stay within the indexed type");
8557
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008558 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008559 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Elt));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008560
8561 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
8562 Ty = STy->getElementType(Elt);
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008563 } else if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008564 uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008565 assert(EltSize && "Cannot index into a zero-sized array");
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008566 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008567 Offset %= EltSize;
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008568 Ty = AT->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008569 } else {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008570 // Otherwise, we can't index into the middle of this atomic type, bail.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008571 return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008572 }
8573 }
8574
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008575 return Ty;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008576}
8577
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008578/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
8579Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8580 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8581
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008582 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008583 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
8584 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008585 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8586 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
8587 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
8588 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00008589 Worklist.Add(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008590 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
8591 return &CI;
8592 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008593
8594 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
8595 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
8596 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
8597 // non-type-safe code.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008598 if (TD && GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008599 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
8600 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +00008601 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, *this));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008602 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
8603
8604 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
8605 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
8606 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
8607 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008608 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008609 if (FindElementAtOffset(GEPIdxTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008610 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
8611 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
8612 // two.
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +00008613 Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(GEP)->isInBounds() ?
8614 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(OrigBase,
8615 NewIndices.begin(), NewIndices.end()) :
8616 Builder->CreateGEP(OrigBase, NewIndices.begin(), NewIndices.end());
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008617 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008618
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008619 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
8620 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
8621 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
8622 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008623 }
8624 }
8625 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008626 }
8627
8628 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8629}
8630
Eli Friedmaneb7f7a82009-07-13 20:58:59 +00008631/// commonIntCastTransforms - This function implements the common transforms
8632/// for trunc, zext, and sext.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008633Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8634 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8635 return Result;
8636
8637 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8638 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8639 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008640 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8641 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008642
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008643 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
8644 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00008645 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(CI))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008646 return &CI;
8647
8648 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
8649 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008650 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
8651 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008652 return 0;
8653
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008654 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008655 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008656 // Only do this if the dest type is a simple type, don't convert the
8657 // expression tree to something weird like i93 unless the source is also
8658 // strange.
Chris Lattner6b583912009-11-10 17:00:47 +00008659 if ((isa<VectorType>(DestTy) ||
8660 ShouldChangeType(SrcI->getType(), DestTy, TD)) &&
8661 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
8662 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008663 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008664 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
8665 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
8666 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
8667 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008668 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008669 bool DoXForm = false;
8670 bool JustReplace = false;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008671 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
8672 default:
8673 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
8674 // get here because of the check above.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008675 llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type");
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008676 case Instruction::Trunc:
8677 DoXForm = true;
8678 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008679 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008680 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
Chris Lattner918871e2009-11-07 19:11:46 +00008681
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008682 if (!DoXForm && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008683 // If it's unnecessary to issue an AND to clear the high bits, it's
8684 // always profitable to do this xform.
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008685 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, false);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008686 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8687 if (MaskedValueIsZero(TryRes, Mask))
8688 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008689
8690 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008691 if (TryI->use_empty())
8692 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
8693 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008694 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008695 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008696 case Instruction::SExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008697 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008698 if (!DoXForm && !isa<TruncInst>(SrcI) && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008699 // If we do not have to emit the truncate + sext pair, then it's always
8700 // profitable to do this xform.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008701 //
8702 // It's not safe to eliminate the trunc + sext pair if one of the
8703 // eliminated cast is a truncate. e.g.
8704 // t2 = trunc i32 t1 to i16
8705 // t3 = sext i16 t2 to i32
8706 // !=
8707 // i32 t1
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008708 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, true);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008709 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(TryRes);
8710 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
8711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008712
8713 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008714 if (TryI->use_empty())
8715 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008716 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008717 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008718 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008719 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008720
8721 if (DoXForm) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +00008722 DEBUG(errs() << "ICE: EvaluateInDifferentType converting expression type"
8723 " to avoid cast: " << CI);
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008724 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
8725 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008726 if (JustReplace)
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008727 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8728 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008729
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008730 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
8731 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008732 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type!");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008733 case Instruction::Trunc:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008734 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8736 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008737 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008738
8739 // If the high bits are already zero, just replace this cast with the
8740 // result.
8741 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8742 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Res, Mask))
8743 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8744
8745 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008746 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
8747 APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008748 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008749 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008750 case Instruction::SExt: {
8751 // If the high bits are already filled with sign bit, just replace this
8752 // cast with the result.
8753 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Res);
8754 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8756
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008757 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008758 return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(Res, Src->getType()), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008759 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008760 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008761 }
8762 }
8763
8764 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
8765 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
8766
8767 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
8768 case Instruction::Add:
8769 case Instruction::Mul:
8770 case Instruction::And:
8771 case Instruction::Or:
8772 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00008773 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008774 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
8775 // Don't insert two casts unless at least one can be eliminated.
8776 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008777 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008778 Value *Op0c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
8779 Value *Op1c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op1, DestTy, Op1->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008780 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008781 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008782 }
8783 }
8784
8785 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
8786 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
8787 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00008788 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008789 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008790 Value *New = Builder->CreateZExt(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008791 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008792 ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008793 }
8794 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008795
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008796 case Instruction::Shl: {
8797 // Canonicalize trunc inside shl, if we can.
8798 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1);
8799 if (CI && DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
8800 CI->getLimitedValue(DestBitSize) < DestBitSize) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008801 Value *Op0c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
8802 Value *Op1c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op1, DestTy, Op1->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008803 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008804 }
8805 break;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008806 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008807 }
8808 return 0;
8809}
8810
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008811Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008812 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8813 return Result;
8814
8815 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8816 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008817 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
8818 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008819
8820 // Canonicalize trunc x to i1 -> (icmp ne (and x, 1), 0)
Eli Friedman191a0ae2009-07-18 09:21:25 +00008821 if (DestBitWidth == 1) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008822 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(Src->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008823 Src = Builder->CreateAnd(Src, One, "tmp");
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008824 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Src->getType());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00008825 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Src, Zero);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008826 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008827
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008828 // Optimize trunc(lshr(), c) to pull the shift through the truncate.
8829 ConstantInt *ShAmtV = 0;
8830 Value *ShiftOp = 0;
8831 if (Src->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00008832 match(Src, m_LShr(m_Value(ShiftOp), m_ConstantInt(ShAmtV)))) {
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008833 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
8834
8835 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
8836 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
8837 if (MaskedValueIsZero(ShiftOp, Mask)) {
8838 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008840
8841 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
8842 // shift.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008843 Value *V1 = Builder->CreateTrunc(ShiftOp, Ty, ShiftOp->getName());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008844 Value *V2 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(ShAmtV, Ty);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008845 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008846 }
8847 }
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +00008848
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008849 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008850}
8851
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008852/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
8853/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
8854Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
8855 bool DoXform) {
8856 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8857 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8858 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8859 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
8860 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
8861
8862 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
8863 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
8864 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8865 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8866 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8867
8868 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008869 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008870 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008871 In = Builder->CreateLShr(In, Sh, In->getName()+".lobit");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008872 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008873 In = Builder->CreateIntCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008874
8875 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008876 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008877 In = Builder->CreateXor(In, One, In->getName()+".not");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008878 }
8879
8880 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8881 }
8882
8883
8884
8885 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8886 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8887 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8888 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8889 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8890 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8891 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8892 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8893 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
8894 // This only works for EQ and NE
8895 ICI->isEquality()) {
8896 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
8897 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
8898 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8899 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
8900 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8901
8902 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
8903 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
8904 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8905
8906 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8907 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
8908 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
8909 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008910 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), isNE);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008911 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008912 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8913 }
8914
8915 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
8916 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8917 if (ShiftAmt) {
8918 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
8919 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008920 In = Builder->CreateLShr(In, ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),ShiftAmt),
8921 In->getName()+".lobit");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008922 }
8923
8924 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008925 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008926 In = Builder->CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008927 }
8928
8929 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8931 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008932 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008933 }
8934 }
8935 }
8936
Nick Lewycky55bd8bd2009-11-23 03:17:33 +00008937 // icmp ne A, B is equal to xor A, B when A and B only really have one bit.
8938 // It is also profitable to transform icmp eq into not(xor(A, B)) because that
8939 // may lead to additional simplifications.
8940 if (ICI->isEquality() && CI.getType() == ICI->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
8941 if (const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())) {
8942 uint32_t BitWidth = ITy->getBitWidth();
Nick Lewycky83e8ec72009-12-05 05:00:00 +00008943 Value *LHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8944 Value *RHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
Nick Lewycky55bd8bd2009-11-23 03:17:33 +00008945
Nick Lewycky83e8ec72009-12-05 05:00:00 +00008946 APInt KnownZeroLHS(BitWidth, 0), KnownOneLHS(BitWidth, 0);
8947 APInt KnownZeroRHS(BitWidth, 0), KnownOneRHS(BitWidth, 0);
8948 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
8949 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, TypeMask, KnownZeroLHS, KnownOneLHS);
8950 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, TypeMask, KnownZeroRHS, KnownOneRHS);
Nick Lewycky55bd8bd2009-11-23 03:17:33 +00008951
Nick Lewycky83e8ec72009-12-05 05:00:00 +00008952 if (KnownZeroLHS == KnownZeroRHS && KnownOneLHS == KnownOneRHS) {
8953 APInt KnownBits = KnownZeroLHS | KnownOneLHS;
8954 APInt UnknownBit = ~KnownBits;
8955 if (UnknownBit.countPopulation() == 1) {
Nick Lewycky55bd8bd2009-11-23 03:17:33 +00008956 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8957
Nick Lewycky83e8ec72009-12-05 05:00:00 +00008958 Value *Result = Builder->CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
8959
8960 // Mask off any bits that are set and won't be shifted away.
8961 if (KnownOneLHS.uge(UnknownBit))
8962 Result = Builder->CreateAnd(Result,
8963 ConstantInt::get(ITy, UnknownBit));
8964
8965 // Shift the bit we're testing down to the lsb.
8966 Result = Builder->CreateLShr(
8967 Result, ConstantInt::get(ITy, UnknownBit.countTrailingZeros()));
8968
Nick Lewycky55bd8bd2009-11-23 03:17:33 +00008969 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Nick Lewycky83e8ec72009-12-05 05:00:00 +00008970 Result = Builder->CreateXor(Result, ConstantInt::get(ITy, 1));
8971 Result->takeName(ICI);
8972 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Result);
Nick Lewycky55bd8bd2009-11-23 03:17:33 +00008973 }
8974 }
8975 }
8976 }
8977
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008978 return 0;
8979}
8980
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008981Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008982 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8983 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8984 return Result;
8985
8986 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8987
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008988 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8989 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8990 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8991 if (TruncInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
8992 // Get the sizes of the types involved. We know that the intermediate type
8993 // will be smaller than A or C, but don't know the relation between A and C.
8994 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008995 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8996 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8997 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008998 // If we're actually extending zero bits, then if
8999 // SrcSize < DstSize: zext(a & mask)
9000 // SrcSize == DstSize: a & mask
9001 // SrcSize > DstSize: trunc(a) & mask
9002 if (SrcSize < DstSize) {
9003 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009004 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(A->getType(), AndValue);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009005 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(A, AndConst, CSrc->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00009006 return new ZExtInst(And, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009007 }
9008
9009 if (SrcSize == DstSize) {
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00009010 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009011 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, ConstantInt::get(A->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009012 AndValue));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009013 }
9014 if (SrcSize > DstSize) {
9015 Value *Trunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(A, CI.getType(), "tmp");
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00009016 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DstSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009017 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Trunc,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009018 ConstantInt::get(Trunc->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009019 AndValue));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009020 }
9021 }
9022
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00009023 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
9024 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00009025
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00009026 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
9027 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
9028 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
9029 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
9030 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
9031 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
9032 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
9033 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
9034 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00009035 Value *LCast = Builder->CreateZExt(LHS, CI.getType(), LHS->getName());
9036 Value *RCast = Builder->CreateZExt(RHS, CI.getType(), RHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009037 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00009038 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00009039 }
9040
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00009041 // zext(trunc(t) & C) -> (t & zext(C)).
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00009042 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && SrcI->hasOneUse())
9043 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
9044 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0))) {
9045 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00009046 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType())
9047 return
9048 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(TI0,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00009049 ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00009050 }
9051
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00009052 // zext((trunc(t) & C) ^ C) -> ((t & zext(C)) ^ zext(C)).
9053 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor && SrcI->hasOneUse())
9054 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
9055 if (BinaryOperator *And = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI->getOperand(0)))
9056 if (And->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && And->hasOneUse() &&
9057 And->getOperand(1) == C)
9058 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(And->getOperand(0))) {
9059 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
9060 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00009061 Constant *ZC = ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009062 Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(TI0, ZC, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00009063 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, ZC);
9064 }
9065 }
9066
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009067 return 0;
9068}
9069
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00009070Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009071 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
9072 return I;
9073
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00009074 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
9075
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009076 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009077 if (Src->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009078 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009079 Constant::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
9080 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00009081
9082 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
9083 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00009084 if (Operator::getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00009085 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009086 unsigned OpBits = Op->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
9087 unsigned MidBits = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
9088 unsigned DestBits = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00009089 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
9090
9091 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
9092 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
9093 // bits, it is already ready.
9094 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
9095 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
9096 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
9097 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
9098 // bits, just sext from i32.
9099 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
9100 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
9101 } else {
9102 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
9103 // bits, just truncate to i32.
9104 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
9105 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
9106 }
9107 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00009108
9109 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
9110 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
9111 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
9112 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
9113 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
9114 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
9115 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
9116 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
9117 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
9118 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
9119 // into:
9120 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
9121 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
9122 Value *A = 0;
9123 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
9124 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009125 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00009126 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
9127 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
9128 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009129 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
9130 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00009131 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009132 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009133 I = Builder->CreateShl(I, ShAmtV, CI.getName());
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00009134 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
9135 }
9136 }
9137
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009138 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009139}
9140
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009141/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
9142/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009143static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00009144 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00009145 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009146 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00009147 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
9148 if (!losesInfo)
Owen Anderson6f83c9c2009-07-27 20:59:43 +00009149 return ConstantFP::get(*Context, F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009150 return 0;
9151}
9152
9153/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
9154/// through it until we get the source value.
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00009155static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009156 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
9157 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009158 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009159
9160 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
9161 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
9162 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
9163 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009164 if (CFP->getType() == Type::getPPC_FP128Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009165 return V; // No constant folding of this.
9166 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009167 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009168 return V;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009169 if (CFP->getType() == Type::getDoubleTy(*Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009170 return V; // Won't shrink.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009171 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009172 return V;
9173 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
9174 }
9175
9176 return V;
9177}
9178
9179Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
9180 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
9181 return I;
9182
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009183 // If we have fptrunc(fadd (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009184 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009185 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to fadd/fsub/fmul/fdiv as well as
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009186 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
9187 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
9188 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
9189 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
9190 default: break;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009191 case Instruction::FAdd:
9192 case Instruction::FSub:
9193 case Instruction::FMul:
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009194 case Instruction::FDiv:
9195 case Instruction::FRem:
9196 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009197 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0), Context);
9198 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009199 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
9200 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009201 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009202 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
9203 // the cast, do this xform.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009204 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
9205 RHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00009206 LHSTrunc = Builder->CreateFPExt(LHSTrunc, CI.getType());
9207 RHSTrunc = Builder->CreateFPExt(RHSTrunc, CI.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009208 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00009209 }
9210 }
9211 break;
9212 }
9213 }
9214 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009215}
9216
9217Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
9218 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
9219}
9220
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00009221Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00009222 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
9223 if (OpI == 0)
9224 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
9225
9226 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
9227 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
9228 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
9229 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
9230 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
9231 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
9232 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
9233 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009234 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00009235 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
9236 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00009237
9238 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009239}
9240
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00009241Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00009242 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
9243 if (OpI == 0)
9244 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
9245
9246 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
9247 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
9248 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
9249 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
9250 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
9251 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
9252 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
9253 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009254 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <=
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00009255 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
9256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00009257
9258 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009259}
9260
9261Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
9262 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
9263}
9264
9265Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
9266 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
9267}
9268
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00009269Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI) {
9270 // If the destination integer type is smaller than the intptr_t type for
9271 // this target, do a ptrtoint to intptr_t then do a trunc. This allows the
9272 // trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for extending
9273 // ptrtoint's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero extends its
9274 // pointers.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00009275 if (TD &&
9276 CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009277 Value *P = Builder->CreatePtrToInt(CI.getOperand(0),
9278 TD->getIntPtrType(CI.getContext()),
9279 "tmp");
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00009280 return new TruncInst(P, CI.getType());
9281 }
9282
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009283 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009284}
9285
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00009286Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00009287 // If the source integer type is larger than the intptr_t type for
9288 // this target, do a trunc to the intptr_t type, then inttoptr of it. This
9289 // allows the trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for
9290 // extending inttoptr's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero
9291 // extends to pointers.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009292 if (TD && CI.getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() >
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00009293 TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009294 Value *P = Builder->CreateTrunc(CI.getOperand(0),
9295 TD->getIntPtrType(CI.getContext()), "tmp");
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00009296 return new IntToPtrInst(P, CI.getType());
9297 }
9298
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00009299 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
9300 return I;
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00009301
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00009302 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009303}
9304
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009305Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009306 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
9307 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
9308 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
9309 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
9310 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
9311
Eli Friedman7e25d452009-07-13 20:53:00 +00009312 if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009313 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
9314 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009315 } else {
9316 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
9317 return Result;
9318 }
9319
9320
9321 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
9322 // be replaced by the operand.
9323 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
9324 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
9325
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009326 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009327 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
9328 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
9329 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
9330
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00009331 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
9332 // required for changing types.
9333 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
9334 return 0;
9335
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00009336 // If we are casting a alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009337 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00009338 // There is no need to modify malloc calls because it is their bitcast that
9339 // needs to be cleaned up.
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +00009340 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(Src))
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009341 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
9342 return V;
9343
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009344 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
9345 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009346 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009347 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009348 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
9349 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
9350 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
9351 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
9352 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
9353 ++NumZeros;
9354 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00009355
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009356 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
9357 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
9358 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +00009359 return GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
9360 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00009361 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009362 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00009363
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00009364 if (const VectorType *DestVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
9365 if (DestVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
9366 if (!isa<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00009367 Value *Elem = Builder->CreateBitCast(Src, DestVTy->getElementType());
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00009368 return InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(DestTy), Elem,
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00009369 Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00009370 }
9371 // FIXME: Canonicalize bitcast(insertelement) -> insertelement(bitcast)
9372 }
9373 }
9374
9375 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
9376 if (SrcVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
9377 if (!isa<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009378 Value *Elem =
9379 Builder->CreateExtractElement(Src,
9380 Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00009381 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Elem, DestTy);
9382 }
9383 }
9384 }
9385
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009386 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
9387 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
9388 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
9389 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009390 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00009391 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
9392 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
9393 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
9394 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009395 CastInst *Tmp;
9396 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
9397 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
9398 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
9399 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
9400 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
9401 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
9402 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00009403 Value *LHS = Builder->CreateBitCast(SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy);
9404 Value *RHS = Builder->CreateBitCast(SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009405 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
9406 // know the vector types match #elts.
9407 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00009408 }
9409 }
9410 }
9411 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009412 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009413}
9414
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009415/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
9416/// %C = or %A, %B
9417/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
9418/// into:
9419/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
9420/// %D = or %A, %C
9421///
9422/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
9423/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
9424/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
9425///
9426static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
9427 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
9428 case Instruction::Add:
9429 case Instruction::Mul:
9430 case Instruction::And:
9431 case Instruction::Or:
9432 case Instruction::Xor:
9433 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
9434 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
9435 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00009436 case Instruction::LShr:
9437 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009438 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009439 default:
9440 return 0; // Cannot fold
9441 }
9442}
9443
9444/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
9445/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009446static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00009447 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009448 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009449 default: llvm_unreachable("This cannot happen!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009450 case Instruction::Add:
9451 case Instruction::Sub:
9452 case Instruction::Or:
9453 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009454 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00009455 case Instruction::LShr:
9456 case Instruction::AShr:
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009457 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009458 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009459 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009460 case Instruction::Mul:
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009461 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009462 }
9463}
9464
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009465/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
9466/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
9467Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
9468 Instruction *FI) {
9469 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
9470 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
9471 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009472 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009473 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
9474 return 0;
9475 } else {
9476 return 0; // unknown unary op.
9477 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009478
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009479 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009480 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +00009481 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009482 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009483 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009484 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009485 }
9486
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009487 // Only handle binary operators here.
9488 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009489 return 0;
9490
9491 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
9492 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
9493 bool MatchIsOpZero;
9494 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9495 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9496 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9497 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9498 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9499 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9500 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9501 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9502 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9503 MatchIsOpZero = false;
9504 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
9505 return 0;
9506 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9507 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9508 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9509 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9510 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9511 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9512 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9513 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9514 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9515 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9516 } else {
9517 return 0;
9518 }
9519
9520 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009521 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
9522 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009523 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
9524
9525 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
9526 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009527 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009528 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009529 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009530 }
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009531 llvm_unreachable("Shouldn't get here");
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00009532 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009533}
9534
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009535static bool isSelect01(Constant *C1, Constant *C2) {
9536 ConstantInt *C1I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C1);
9537 if (!C1I)
9538 return false;
9539 ConstantInt *C2I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C2);
9540 if (!C2I)
9541 return false;
9542 return (C1I->isZero() || C1I->isOne()) && (C2I->isZero() || C2I->isOne());
9543}
9544
9545/// FoldSelectIntoOp - Try fold the select into one of the operands to
9546/// facilitate further optimization.
9547Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value *TrueVal,
9548 Value *FalseVal) {
9549 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
9550 // transformation we are doing here.
9551 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal)) {
9552 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9553 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal)) {
9554 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
9555 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9556 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
9557 OpToFold = 1;
9558 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
9559 OpToFold = 2;
9560 }
9561
9562 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009563 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009564 Value *OOp = TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9565 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9566 // between 0 and 1.
9567 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9568 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OOp, C);
9569 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9570 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
9571 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
9572 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009573 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009574 }
9575 }
9576 }
9577 }
9578 }
9579
9580 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal)) {
9581 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9582 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal)) {
9583 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
9584 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9585 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
9586 OpToFold = 1;
9587 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
9588 OpToFold = 2;
9589 }
9590
9591 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009592 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009593 Value *OOp = FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9594 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9595 // between 0 and 1.
9596 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9597 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C, OOp);
9598 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9599 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
9600 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
9601 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009602 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009603 }
9604 }
9605 }
9606 }
9607 }
9608
9609 return 0;
9610}
9611
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009612/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
9613/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
9614///
9615Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
9616 ICmpInst *ICI) {
9617 bool Changed = false;
9618 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
9619 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
9620 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
9621 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9622 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9623
9624 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
9625 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
9626 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
9627 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009628 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009629 switch (Pred) {
9630 default: break;
9631 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
9632 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
9633 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
9634 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
9635 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9636 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00009637 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009638 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9639 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9640 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9641 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9642 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9643 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9644 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9645 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9646 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9647 Changed = true;
9648 }
9649 break;
9650 }
9651 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9652 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
9653 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
9654 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
9655 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9656 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00009657 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009658 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9659 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9660 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9661 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9662 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9663 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9664 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9665 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9666 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9667 Changed = true;
9668 }
9669 break;
9670 }
9671 }
9672
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009673 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
9674 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009675 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009676 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()) &&
9677 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009678 Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009679 else if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()) &&
9680 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009681 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
9682
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009683 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
9684 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
9685 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
9686 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
9687 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
9688
9689 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
9690 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
9691 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009692 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009693 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009694 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009695 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009696 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +00009697 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009698 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00009699 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
9700 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009701 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
9702
9703 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009704 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009705 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
9706
9707 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
9708 }
9709 }
9710 }
9711
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009712 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
9713 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
9714 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9715 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9716 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
9717 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9718 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9719 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9720
9721 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
9722 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
9723 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9725 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
9726 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9727 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9728 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9729 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009730 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
9731}
9732
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009733
Chris Lattner7f239582009-10-22 00:17:26 +00009734/// CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock - SI is a select whose condition is a
9735/// PHI node (but the two may be in different blocks). See if the true/false
9736/// values (V) are live in all of the predecessor blocks of the PHI. For
9737/// example, cases like this cannot be mapped:
9738///
9739/// X = phi [ C1, BB1], [C2, BB2]
9740/// Y = add
9741/// Z = select X, Y, 0
9742///
9743/// because Y is not live in BB1/BB2.
9744///
9745static bool CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(const Value *V,
9746 const SelectInst &SI) {
9747 // If the value is a non-instruction value like a constant or argument, it
9748 // can always be mapped.
9749 const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9750 if (I == 0) return true;
9751
9752 // If V is a PHI node defined in the same block as the condition PHI, we can
9753 // map the arguments.
9754 const PHINode *CondPHI = cast<PHINode>(SI.getCondition());
9755
9756 if (const PHINode *VP = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I))
9757 if (VP->getParent() == CondPHI->getParent())
9758 return true;
9759
9760 // Otherwise, if the PHI and select are defined in the same block and if V is
9761 // defined in a different block, then we can transform it.
9762 if (SI.getParent() == CondPHI->getParent() &&
9763 I->getParent() != CondPHI->getParent())
9764 return true;
9765
9766 // Otherwise we have a 'hard' case and we can't tell without doing more
9767 // detailed dominator based analysis, punt.
9768 return false;
9769}
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009770
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +00009771/// FoldSPFofSPF - We have an SPF (e.g. a min or max) of an SPF of the form:
9772/// SPF2(SPF1(A, B), C)
9773Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSPFofSPF(Instruction *Inner,
9774 SelectPatternFlavor SPF1,
9775 Value *A, Value *B,
9776 Instruction &Outer,
9777 SelectPatternFlavor SPF2, Value *C) {
9778 if (C == A || C == B) {
9779 // MAX(MAX(A, B), B) -> MAX(A, B)
9780 // MIN(MIN(a, b), a) -> MIN(a, b)
9781 if (SPF1 == SPF2)
9782 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(Outer, Inner);
9783
9784 // MAX(MIN(a, b), a) -> a
9785 // MIN(MAX(a, b), a) -> a
Daniel Dunbareddfaaf2009-12-21 23:27:57 +00009786 if ((SPF1 == SPF_SMIN && SPF2 == SPF_SMAX) ||
9787 (SPF1 == SPF_SMAX && SPF2 == SPF_SMIN) ||
9788 (SPF1 == SPF_UMIN && SPF2 == SPF_UMAX) ||
9789 (SPF1 == SPF_UMAX && SPF2 == SPF_UMIN))
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +00009790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(Outer, C);
9791 }
9792
9793 // TODO: MIN(MIN(A, 23), 97)
9794 return 0;
9795}
9796
9797
9798
9799
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009800Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009801 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
9802 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9803 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9804
9805 // select true, X, Y -> X
9806 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009807 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009808 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009809
9810 // select C, X, X -> X
9811 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
9812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9813
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009814 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
9815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9816 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
9817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9818 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
9819 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
9820 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9821 else
9822 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9823 }
9824
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009825 if (SI.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context)) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009826 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009827 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009828 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009829 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009830 } else {
9831 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
9832 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009833 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009834 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009835 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009836 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009837 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009838 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009839 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009840 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009841 } else {
9842 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
9843 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009844 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009845 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009846 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009847 }
9848 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009849
9850 // select a, b, a -> a&b
9851 // select a, a, b -> a|b
9852 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009853 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009854 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009855 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009856 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009857
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009858 // Selecting between two integer constants?
9859 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
9860 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009861 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009862 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009863 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009864 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009865 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009866 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009867 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009868 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009869 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009870 }
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009871
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009872 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009873 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009874 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009875 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
9876 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009877 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00009878 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009879 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
9880 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
9881 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009882 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
9883 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
9884 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009885 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
9886 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009887 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
9888 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009889 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009890 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009891 Value *V = ICA;
9892 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009893 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009894 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
9895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
9896 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009897 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009898 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009899
9900 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009901 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
9902 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009903 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009904 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9905 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9906 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9907 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9908 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9909 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9910 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9911 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9912 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009914 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009915 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009916 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009917 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009918 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009919
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009920 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009921 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009922 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9923 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9924 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9925 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9926 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9927 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9928 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9929 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9930 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
9931 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9932 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009933 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009934 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
9935 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009936 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009937 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009938 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009939 }
9940
9941 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009942 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
9943 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
9944 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009945
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009946 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
9947 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
9948 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009949 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
9950
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009951 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
9952 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
9953 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
9954 return IV;
9955
9956 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
9957 // even legal for FP.
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009958 if ((TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9959 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9960 (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9961 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009962 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009963 } else if ((FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9964 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9965 (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9966 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009967 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
9968 }
9969
9970 if (AddOp) {
9971 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
9972 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
9973 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
9974 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
9975 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
9976 }
9977
9978 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009979 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
9980 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
9981 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
9982 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00009983 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009984 } else {
9985 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009986 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00009987 "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009988 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009989
9990 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
9991 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
9992 if (AddOp != TI)
9993 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
9994 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009995 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
9996 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009997
9998 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009999 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +000010000 }
10001 }
10002 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010003
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +000010004 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +000010005 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +000010006 if (Instruction *FoldI = FoldSelectIntoOp(SI, TrueVal, FalseVal))
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +000010007 return FoldI;
Chris Lattnerb109b5c2009-12-21 06:03:05 +000010008
10009 // MAX(MAX(a, b), a) -> MAX(a, b)
10010 // MIN(MIN(a, b), a) -> MIN(a, b)
10011 // MAX(MIN(a, b), a) -> a
10012 // MIN(MAX(a, b), a) -> a
10013 Value *LHS, *RHS, *LHS2, *RHS2;
10014 if (SelectPatternFlavor SPF = MatchSelectPattern(&SI, LHS, RHS)) {
10015 if (SelectPatternFlavor SPF2 = MatchSelectPattern(LHS, LHS2, RHS2))
10016 if (Instruction *R = FoldSPFofSPF(cast<Instruction>(LHS),SPF2,LHS2,RHS2,
10017 SI, SPF, RHS))
10018 return R;
10019 if (SelectPatternFlavor SPF2 = MatchSelectPattern(RHS, LHS2, RHS2))
10020 if (Instruction *R = FoldSPFofSPF(cast<Instruction>(RHS),SPF2,LHS2,RHS2,
10021 SI, SPF, LHS))
10022 return R;
10023 }
10024
10025 // TODO.
10026 // ABS(-X) -> ABS(X)
10027 // ABS(ABS(X)) -> ABS(X)
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +000010028 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +000010029
Chris Lattner7f239582009-10-22 00:17:26 +000010030 // See if we can fold the select into a phi node if the condition is a select.
10031 if (isa<PHINode>(SI.getCondition()))
10032 // The true/false values have to be live in the PHI predecessor's blocks.
10033 if (CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(TrueVal, SI) &&
10034 CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(FalseVal, SI))
10035 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(SI))
10036 return NV;
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +000010037
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +000010038 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
10039 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
10040 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
10041 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
10042 return &SI;
10043 }
10044
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +000010045 return 0;
10046}
10047
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010048/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
10049/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
10050/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
10051/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
10052/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
10053///
10054static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
10055 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +000010056
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010057 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
10058 if (!U) return Align;
10059
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +000010060 switch (Operator::getOpcode(U)) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010061 default: break;
10062 case Instruction::BitCast:
10063 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
10064 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +000010065 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
10066 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +000010067 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010068 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
10069 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +000010070 AllZeroOperands = false;
10071 break;
10072 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +000010073
10074 if (AllZeroOperands) {
10075 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010076 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +000010077 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010078 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +000010079 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010080 }
10081
10082 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
10083 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
10084 // of the global.
10085 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
Dan Gohmanecd0fb52009-02-16 23:02:21 +000010086 if (GV->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
10087 Align = GV->getAlignment();
10088 else {
10089 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
10090 Align = PrefAlign;
10091 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010092 }
Chris Lattner42ebefa2009-09-27 21:42:46 +000010093 } else if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(V)) {
10094 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up.
10095 if (AI->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
10096 Align = AI->getAlignment();
10097 else {
10098 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
10099 Align = PrefAlign;
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010100 }
10101 }
10102
10103 return Align;
10104}
10105
10106/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
10107/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
10108/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
10109/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
10110unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
10111 unsigned PrefAlign) {
10112 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
10113 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
10114 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
10115 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
10116 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
10117 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
10118 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
10119
10120 if (PrefAlign > Align)
10121 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
10122
10123 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
10124 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +000010125}
10126
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010127Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010128 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanbc989d42009-02-22 18:06:32 +000010129 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010130 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +000010131 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010132
10133 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000010134 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +000010135 MinAlign, false));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010136 return MI;
10137 }
10138
10139 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
10140 // load/store.
10141 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
10142 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
10143
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010144 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
10145 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
10146 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
10147 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010148 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010149 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
10150
10151 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010152 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010153
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010154 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010155 Type *NewPtrTy =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010156 PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(*Context, Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010157
10158 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
10159 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
10160 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
10161 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
10162 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
10163 // integer datatype.
10164 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
10165 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010166 if (TD && SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010167 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
10168 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +000010169 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010170 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
10171 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
10172 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
10173 else
10174 break;
10175 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
10176 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
10177 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
10178 else
10179 break;
10180 } else
10181 break;
10182 }
10183
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +000010184 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010185 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010186 }
10187 }
10188
10189
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010190 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
10191 // infer, use it.
10192 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
10193 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
10194
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000010195 Value *Src = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy);
10196 Value *Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010197 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
10198 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
10199 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
10200
10201 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010202 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +000010203 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010204}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +000010205
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010206Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
10207 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +000010208 if (MI->getAlignment() < Alignment) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000010209 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +000010210 Alignment, false));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010211 return MI;
10212 }
10213
10214 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
10215 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
10216 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010217 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::getInt8Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010218 return 0;
10219 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +000010220 Alignment = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010221
10222 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
10223 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
10224
10225 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
10226 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010227 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(*Context, Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010228
10229 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000010230 Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010231
10232 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
10233 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
10234
10235 // Extract the fill value and store.
10236 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000010237 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010238 Dest, false, Alignment), *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010239
10240 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010241 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010242 return MI;
10243 }
10244
10245 return 0;
10246}
10247
10248
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +000010249/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
10250/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
10251/// the heavy lifting.
10252///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010253Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Victor Hernandez66284e02009-10-24 04:23:03 +000010254 if (isFreeCall(&CI))
10255 return visitFree(CI);
10256
Chris Lattneraab6ec42009-05-13 17:39:14 +000010257 // If the caller function is nounwind, mark the call as nounwind, even if the
10258 // callee isn't.
10259 if (CI.getParent()->getParent()->doesNotThrow() &&
10260 !CI.doesNotThrow()) {
10261 CI.setDoesNotThrow();
10262 return &CI;
10263 }
10264
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +000010265 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
10266 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
10267
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010268 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
10269 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +000010270 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010271 bool Changed = false;
10272
10273 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
10274 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
10275 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
10276
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010277 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010278 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010279 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
10280 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
10281 // alignment is sufficient.
10282 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010283 }
10284
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010285 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
10286 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
10287 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010288 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010289 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
10290 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
10291 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +000010292 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy;
10293 const Type *Tys[1];
10294 Tys[0] = CI.getOperand(3)->getType();
10295 CI.setOperand(0,
10296 Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID, Tys, 1));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010297 Changed = true;
10298 }
Eli Friedman0c826d92009-12-17 21:07:31 +000010299 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +000010300
Eli Friedman0c826d92009-12-17 21:07:31 +000010301 if (MemTransferInst *MTI = dyn_cast<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +000010302 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
Eli Friedman0c826d92009-12-17 21:07:31 +000010303 if (MTI->getSource() == MTI->getDest())
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +000010304 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +000010305 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010306
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +000010307 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
10308 // set, update the alignment.
Chris Lattner3ce5e882009-03-08 03:37:16 +000010309 if (isa<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +000010310 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
10311 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +000010312 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
10313 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
10314 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +000010315 }
10316
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +000010317 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010318 }
10319
10320 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
10321 default: break;
10322 case Intrinsic::bswap:
10323 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
10324 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
10325 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
10326 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere33d4132010-01-01 18:34:40 +000010327
10328 // bswap(trunc(bswap(x))) -> trunc(lshr(x, c))
10329 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
10330 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(TI->getOperand(0)))
10331 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
10332 unsigned C = Operand->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() -
10333 TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10334 Value *CV = ConstantInt::get(Operand->getType(), C);
10335 Value *V = Builder->CreateLShr(Operand->getOperand(1), CV);
10336 return new TruncInst(V, TI->getType());
10337 }
10338 }
10339
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010340 break;
Chris Lattnerd27f9112010-01-01 01:52:15 +000010341 case Intrinsic::powi:
10342 if (ConstantInt *Power = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getOperand(2))) {
10343 // powi(x, 0) -> 1.0
10344 if (Power->isZero())
10345 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, ConstantFP::get(CI.getType(), 1.0));
10346 // powi(x, 1) -> x
10347 if (Power->isOne())
10348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, II->getOperand(1));
10349 // powi(x, -1) -> 1/x
Chris Lattnerf9ead872010-01-01 01:54:08 +000010350 if (Power->isAllOnesValue())
10351 return BinaryOperator::CreateFDiv(ConstantFP::get(CI.getType(), 1.0),
10352 II->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerd27f9112010-01-01 01:52:15 +000010353 }
10354 break;
10355
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010356 case Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow: {
10357 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1), *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
10358 const IntegerType *IT = cast<IntegerType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
10359 uint32_t BitWidth = IT->getBitWidth();
10360 APInt Mask = APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner998e25a2009-11-26 22:08:06 +000010361 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0);
10362 APInt LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010363 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
10364 bool LHSKnownNegative = LHSKnownOne[BitWidth - 1];
10365 bool LHSKnownPositive = LHSKnownZero[BitWidth - 1];
10366
10367 if (LHSKnownNegative || LHSKnownPositive) {
Chris Lattner998e25a2009-11-26 22:08:06 +000010368 APInt RHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0);
10369 APInt RHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010370 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
10371 bool RHSKnownNegative = RHSKnownOne[BitWidth - 1];
10372 bool RHSKnownPositive = RHSKnownZero[BitWidth - 1];
10373 if (LHSKnownNegative && RHSKnownNegative) {
10374 // The sign bit is set in both cases: this MUST overflow.
10375 // Create a simple add instruction, and insert it into the struct.
10376 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHS, RHS, "", &CI);
10377 Worklist.Add(Add);
Chris Lattnercd188e92009-11-29 02:57:29 +000010378 Constant *V[] = {
10379 UndefValue::get(LHS->getType()), ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context)
10380 };
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010381 Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(*Context, V, 2, false);
10382 return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, Add, 0);
10383 }
10384
10385 if (LHSKnownPositive && RHSKnownPositive) {
10386 // The sign bit is clear in both cases: this CANNOT overflow.
10387 // Create a simple add instruction, and insert it into the struct.
10388 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateNUWAdd(LHS, RHS, "", &CI);
10389 Worklist.Add(Add);
Chris Lattnercd188e92009-11-29 02:57:29 +000010390 Constant *V[] = {
10391 UndefValue::get(LHS->getType()), ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context)
10392 };
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010393 Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(*Context, V, 2, false);
10394 return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, Add, 0);
10395 }
10396 }
10397 }
10398 // FALL THROUGH uadd into sadd
10399 case Intrinsic::sadd_with_overflow:
10400 // Canonicalize constants into the RHS.
10401 if (isa<Constant>(II->getOperand(1)) &&
10402 !isa<Constant>(II->getOperand(2))) {
10403 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
10404 II->setOperand(1, II->getOperand(2));
10405 II->setOperand(2, LHS);
10406 return II;
10407 }
10408
10409 // X + undef -> undef
10410 if (isa<UndefValue>(II->getOperand(2)))
10411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
10412
10413 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getOperand(2))) {
10414 // X + 0 -> {X, false}
10415 if (RHS->isZero()) {
10416 Constant *V[] = {
Chris Lattnercd188e92009-11-29 02:57:29 +000010417 UndefValue::get(II->getOperand(0)->getType()),
10418 ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context)
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010419 };
10420 Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(*Context, V, 2, false);
10421 return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, II->getOperand(1), 0);
10422 }
10423 }
10424 break;
10425 case Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow:
10426 case Intrinsic::ssub_with_overflow:
10427 // undef - X -> undef
10428 // X - undef -> undef
10429 if (isa<UndefValue>(II->getOperand(1)) ||
10430 isa<UndefValue>(II->getOperand(2)))
10431 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
10432
10433 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getOperand(2))) {
10434 // X - 0 -> {X, false}
10435 if (RHS->isZero()) {
10436 Constant *V[] = {
Chris Lattnercd188e92009-11-29 02:57:29 +000010437 UndefValue::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType()),
10438 ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context)
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010439 };
10440 Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(*Context, V, 2, false);
10441 return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, II->getOperand(1), 0);
10442 }
10443 }
10444 break;
10445 case Intrinsic::umul_with_overflow:
10446 case Intrinsic::smul_with_overflow:
10447 // Canonicalize constants into the RHS.
10448 if (isa<Constant>(II->getOperand(1)) &&
10449 !isa<Constant>(II->getOperand(2))) {
10450 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
10451 II->setOperand(1, II->getOperand(2));
10452 II->setOperand(2, LHS);
10453 return II;
10454 }
10455
10456 // X * undef -> undef
10457 if (isa<UndefValue>(II->getOperand(2)))
10458 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
10459
10460 if (ConstantInt *RHSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getOperand(2))) {
10461 // X*0 -> {0, false}
10462 if (RHSI->isZero())
10463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(II->getType()));
10464
10465 // X * 1 -> {X, false}
10466 if (RHSI->equalsInt(1)) {
Chris Lattnercd188e92009-11-29 02:57:29 +000010467 Constant *V[] = {
10468 UndefValue::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType()),
10469 ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context)
10470 };
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010471 Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(*Context, V, 2, false);
Chris Lattnercd188e92009-11-29 02:57:29 +000010472 return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, II->getOperand(1), 0);
Chris Lattner2bbac752009-11-26 21:42:47 +000010473 }
10474 }
10475 break;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010476 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
10477 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
10478 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
10479 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
10480 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
10481 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
10482 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
10483 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000010484 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1),
10485 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010486 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010487 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010488 break;
10489 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
10490 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
10491 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
10492 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
10493 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010494 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000010495 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010496 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
10497 }
10498 break;
10499 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
10500 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
10501 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010502 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
10503 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
10504 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010505 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000010506 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010507 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
10508 }
10509 break;
10510
10511 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
10512 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
10513 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000010514 unsigned VWidth =
10515 cast<VectorType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType())->getNumElements();
10516 APInt DemandedElts(VWidth, 1);
10517 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
10518 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010519 UndefElts)) {
10520 II->setOperand(1, V);
10521 return II;
10522 }
10523 break;
10524 }
10525
10526 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
10527 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
10528 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
10529 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010530
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010531 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
10532 bool AllEltsOk = true;
10533 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
10534 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
10535 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
10536 AllEltsOk = false;
10537 break;
10538 }
10539 }
10540
10541 if (AllEltsOk) {
10542 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000010543 Value *Op0 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType());
10544 Value *Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType());
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010545 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +000010546
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010547 // Only extract each element once.
10548 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
10549 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
10550
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +000010551 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010552 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
10553 continue;
10554 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
10555 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
10556
10557 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010558 ExtractedElts[Idx] =
10559 Builder->CreateExtractElement(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1,
10560 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Idx&15, false),
10561 "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +000010562 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +000010563
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010564 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010565 Result = Builder->CreateInsertElement(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
10566 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i, false),
10567 "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +000010568 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010569 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +000010570 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010571 }
10572 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +000010573
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010574 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
10575 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
10576 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
10577 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
10578 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
10579 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
10580 if (&*++BI == II)
10581 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +000010582 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010583 }
10584
10585 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
10586 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
10587 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
10588 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
10589 bool CannotRemove = false;
10590 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000010591 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) || isMalloc(BI)) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010592 CannotRemove = true;
10593 break;
10594 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +000010595 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
10596 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
10597 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
10598 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
10599 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
10600 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
10601 } else {
10602 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
10603 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +000010604 CannotRemove = true;
10605 break;
10606 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010607 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +000010608 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010609
10610 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
10611 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
10612 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
10613 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
10614 break;
10615 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010616 }
10617
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +000010618 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010619}
10620
10621// InvokeInst simplification
10622//
10623Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010624 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010625}
10626
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +000010627/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
10628/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010629static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
10630 const CastInst * const CI,
10631 const TargetData * const TD,
10632 const int ix) {
10633 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
10634 return false;
10635
10636 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
10637 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
10638 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010639 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010640 return true;
10641
10642 const Type* SrcTy =
10643 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
10644 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10645 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
10646 return false;
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010647 if (!TD || TD->getTypeAllocSize(SrcTy) != TD->getTypeAllocSize(DstTy))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010648 return false;
10649 return true;
10650}
10651
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010652// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
10653//
10654Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010655 bool Changed = false;
10656
10657 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
10658 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010659 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
10660
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010661 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010662
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010663 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
10664 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
10665 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
10666 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
10667 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000010668 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +000010669 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010670 OldCall);
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000010671 // If OldCall dues not return void then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
10672 // This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010673 if (!OldCall->getType()->isVoidTy())
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000010674 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010675 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
10676 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
10677 return 0;
10678 }
10679
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010680 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
10681 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
10682 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
10683 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000010684 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +000010685 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010686 CS.getInstruction());
10687
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000010688 // If CS dues not return void then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
10689 // This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010690 if (!CS.getInstruction()->getType()->isVoidTy())
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000010691 CS.getInstruction()->
10692 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010693
10694 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
10695 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010696 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000010697 ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010698 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010699 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
10700 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010701
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010702 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
10703 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
10704 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
10705 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
10706
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010707 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10708 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
10709 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +000010710 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010711 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
10712 // the call.
10713 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010714 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
10715 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
10716 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
10717 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
10718 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010719 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010720 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010721 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010722
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010723 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010724 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010725 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010726 Changed = true;
10727 }
10728
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010729 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010730}
10731
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010732// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
10733// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
10734//
10735bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
10736 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
10737 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010738 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
10739 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010740 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +000010741 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010742 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010743 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010744
10745 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
10746 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
10747 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
10748 //
10749 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
10750 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010751 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010752
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010753 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +000010754 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
10755
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010756 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010757 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000010758 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010759 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
10760 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010761 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || !TD ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010762 OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010763 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || !TD ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010764 NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010765 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010766
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010767 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010768 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010769 !NewRetTy->isVoidTy() && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010770 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
10771
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010772 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010773 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010774 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +000010775 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
10776 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010777
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010778 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
10779 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
10780 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
10781 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
10782 if (!Caller->use_empty())
10783 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
10784 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
10785 UI != E; ++UI)
10786 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
10787 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +000010788 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010789 return false;
10790 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010791
10792 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
10793 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010794
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010795 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
10796 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
10797 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +000010798 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010799
10800 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010801 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
10802
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010803 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
10804 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010805 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010806
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010807 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
10808 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010809 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010810 (TD && ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) ||
10811 ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
10812 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) ||
10813 ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010814 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010815 }
10816
10817 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010818 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010819 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010820
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010821 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
10822 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010823 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010824 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
10825 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010826 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
10827 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010828 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +000010829 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010830 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010831 return false;
10832 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010833
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010834 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
10835 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
10836 std::vector<Value*> Args;
10837 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010838 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010839 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
10840
10841 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010842 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010843
10844 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
10845 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010846 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010847
10848 // Add the new return attributes.
10849 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010850 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010851
10852 AI = CS.arg_begin();
10853 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10854 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
10855 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
10856 Args.push_back(*AI);
10857 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +000010858 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010859 false, ParamTy, false);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010860 Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010861 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010862
10863 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010864 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010865 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010866 }
10867
10868 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010869 // now.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010870 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010871 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010872
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010873 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010874 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010875 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000010876 errs() << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
10877 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010878 } else {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010879 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010880 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10881 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
10882 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
10883 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010884 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10885 CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false, PTy, false);
10886 Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010887 } else {
10888 Args.push_back(*AI);
10889 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010890
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010891 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010892 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010893 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010894 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010895 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010896 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010897
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010898 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
10899 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
10900
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010901 if (NewRetTy->isVoidTy())
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010902 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010903
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +000010904 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),
10905 attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010906
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010907 Instruction *NC;
10908 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010909 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010910 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10911 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +000010912 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010913 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010914 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010915 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10916 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010917 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
10918 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +000010919 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010920 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010921 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010922 }
10923
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010924 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010925 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010926 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010927 if (!NV->getType()->isVoidTy()) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010928 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010929 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010930 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010931
10932 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
10933 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
10934 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010935 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010936 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
10937 } else {
10938 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
10939 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
10940 }
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000010941 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010942 } else {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010943 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010944 }
10945 }
10946
Devang Patel1bf5ebc2009-10-13 21:41:20 +000010947
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +000010948 if (!Caller->use_empty())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010949 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +000010950
10951 EraseInstFromFunction(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010952 return true;
10953}
10954
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010955// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
10956// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
10957//
10958Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
10959 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
10960 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10961 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010962 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010963
10964 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
10965 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010966 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010967 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010968
10969 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
10970 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
10971
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +000010972 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010973 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
10974 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
10975
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010976 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010977 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010978 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
10979 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010980 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010981
10982 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
10983 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
10984 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010985 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010986 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
10987 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010988 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010989 break;
10990 }
10991
10992 if (NestTy) {
10993 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
10994 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
10995 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
10996
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010997 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010998 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010999
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011000 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011001 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
11002
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000011003 // Add any result attributes.
11004 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000011005 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011006
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011007 {
11008 unsigned Idx = 1;
11009 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
11010 do {
11011 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011012 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011013 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
11014 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
11015 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
11016 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000011017 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011018 }
11019
11020 if (I == E)
11021 break;
11022
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011023 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011024 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000011025 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011026 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000011027 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011028
11029 ++Idx, ++I;
11030 } while (1);
11031 }
11032
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000011033 // Add any function attributes.
11034 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
11035 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
11036
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011037 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
11038 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011039 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011040
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011041 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011042 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
11043
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011044 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011045 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011046 {
11047 unsigned Idx = 1;
11048 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
11049 E = FTy->param_end();
11050
11051 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011052 if (Idx == NestIdx)
11053 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011054 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011055
11056 if (I == E)
11057 break;
11058
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000011059 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011060 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011061
11062 ++Idx, ++I;
11063 } while (1);
11064 }
11065
11066 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
11067 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011068 FunctionType *NewFTy = FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011069 FTy->isVarArg());
11070 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011071 NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000011072 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF,
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011073 PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +000011074 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),
11075 NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011076
11077 Instruction *NewCaller;
11078 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011079 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
11080 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
11081 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
11082 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011083 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000011084 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011085 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011086 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
11087 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011088 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
11089 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
11090 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
11091 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000011092 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011093 }
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000011094 if (!Caller->getType()->isVoidTy())
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011095 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
11096 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011097 Worklist.Remove(Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011098 return 0;
11099 }
11100 }
11101
11102 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
11103 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
11104 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
11105 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011106 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF :
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000011107 ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000011108 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
11109 return CS.getInstruction();
11110}
11111
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000011112/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(a,c)]
11113/// and if a/b/c and the add's all have a single use, turn this into a phi
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011114/// and a single binop.
11115Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
11116 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000011117 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011118 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000011119 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
11120 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
11121
11122 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
11123 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011124
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000011125 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011126 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011127 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +000011128 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011129 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000011130 // types or GEP's with different index types.
11131 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
11132 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011133 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011134
11135 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
11136 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
11137 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
11138 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
11139 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000011140
11141 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
11142 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
11143 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011144 }
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000011145
11146 // If both LHS and RHS would need a PHI, don't do this transformation,
11147 // because it would increase the number of PHIs entering the block,
11148 // which leads to higher register pressure. This is especially
11149 // bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
11150 if (!LHSVal && !RHSVal)
11151 return 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011152
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000011153 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform!
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000011154
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011155 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011156 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000011157 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000011158 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011159 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
11160 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000011161 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
11162 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000011163 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
11164 LHSVal = NewLHS;
11165 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000011166
11167 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011168 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
11169 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000011170 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
11171 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000011172 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
11173 RHSVal = NewRHS;
11174 }
11175
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000011176 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011177 if (NewLHS || NewRHS) {
11178 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
11179 Instruction *InInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
11180 if (NewLHS) {
11181 Value *NewInLHS = InInst->getOperand(0);
11182 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
11183 }
11184 if (NewRHS) {
11185 Value *NewInRHS = InInst->getOperand(1);
11186 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
11187 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000011188 }
11189 }
11190
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011191 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011192 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000011193 CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +000011194 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000011195 LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011196}
11197
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011198Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
11199 GetElementPtrInst *FirstInst =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
11200
11201 SmallVector<Value*, 16> FixedOperands(FirstInst->op_begin(),
11202 FirstInst->op_end());
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000011203 // This is true if all GEP bases are allocas and if all indices into them are
11204 // constants.
11205 bool AllBasePointersAreAllocas = true;
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000011206
11207 // We don't want to replace this phi if the replacement would require
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000011208 // more than one phi, which leads to higher register pressure. This is
11209 // especially bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000011210 bool NeededPhi = false;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011211
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000011212 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011213 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
11214 GetElementPtrInst *GEP= dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
11215 if (!GEP || !GEP->hasOneUse() || GEP->getType() != FirstInst->getType() ||
11216 GEP->getNumOperands() != FirstInst->getNumOperands())
11217 return 0;
11218
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000011219 // Keep track of whether or not all GEPs are of alloca pointers.
11220 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas &&
11221 (!isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) ||
11222 !GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()))
11223 AllBasePointersAreAllocas = false;
11224
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011225 // Compare the operand lists.
11226 for (unsigned op = 0, e = FirstInst->getNumOperands(); op != e; ++op) {
11227 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op) == GEP->getOperand(op))
11228 continue;
11229
11230 // Don't merge two GEPs when two operands differ (introducing phi nodes)
11231 // if one of the PHIs has a constant for the index. The index may be
11232 // substantially cheaper to compute for the constants, so making it a
11233 // variable index could pessimize the path. This also handles the case
11234 // for struct indices, which must always be constant.
11235 if (isa<ConstantInt>(FirstInst->getOperand(op)) ||
11236 isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(op)))
11237 return 0;
11238
11239 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op)->getType() !=GEP->getOperand(op)->getType())
11240 return 0;
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000011241
11242 // If we already needed a PHI for an earlier operand, and another operand
11243 // also requires a PHI, we'd be introducing more PHIs than we're
11244 // eliminating, which increases register pressure on entry to the PHI's
11245 // block.
11246 if (NeededPhi)
11247 return 0;
11248
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011249 FixedOperands[op] = 0; // Needs a PHI.
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000011250 NeededPhi = true;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011251 }
11252 }
11253
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000011254 // If all of the base pointers of the PHI'd GEPs are from allocas, don't
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000011255 // bother doing this transformation. At best, this will just save a bit of
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000011256 // offset calculation, but all the predecessors will have to materialize the
11257 // stack address into a register anyway. We'd actually rather *clone* the
11258 // load up into the predecessors so that we have a load of a gep of an alloca,
11259 // which can usually all be folded into the load.
11260 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas)
11261 return 0;
11262
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011263 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform. Insert PHI nodes for each operand
11264 // that is variable.
11265 SmallVector<PHINode*, 16> OperandPhis(FixedOperands.size());
11266
11267 bool HasAnyPHIs = false;
11268 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FixedOperands.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11269 if (FixedOperands[i]) continue; // operand doesn't need a phi.
11270 Value *FirstOp = FirstInst->getOperand(i);
11271 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstOp->getType(),
11272 FirstOp->getName()+".pn");
11273 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
11274
11275 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(e);
11276 NewPN->addIncoming(FirstOp, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
11277 OperandPhis[i] = NewPN;
11278 FixedOperands[i] = NewPN;
11279 HasAnyPHIs = true;
11280 }
11281
11282
11283 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
11284 if (HasAnyPHIs) {
11285 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
11286 GetElementPtrInst *InGEP =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
11287 BasicBlock *InBB = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
11288
11289 for (unsigned op = 0, e = OperandPhis.size(); op != e; ++op)
11290 if (PHINode *OpPhi = OperandPhis[op])
11291 OpPhi->addIncoming(InGEP->getOperand(op), InBB);
11292 }
11293 }
11294
11295 Value *Base = FixedOperands[0];
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011296 return cast<GEPOperator>(FirstInst)->isInBounds() ?
11297 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
11298 FixedOperands.end()) :
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000011299 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
11300 FixedOperands.end());
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011301}
11302
11303
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000011304/// isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe to
11305/// sink the load out of the block that defines it. This means that it must be
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000011306/// obvious the value of the load is not changed from the point of the load to
11307/// the end of the block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000011308///
11309/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
11310/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
11311/// to a register.
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000011312static bool isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000011313 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
11314
11315 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
11316 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
11317 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000011318
11319 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
11320 // profitable to do this xform.
11321 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
11322 bool isAddressTaken = false;
11323 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
11324 UI != E; ++UI) {
11325 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
11326 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
11327 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
11328 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
11329 }
11330 isAddressTaken = true;
11331 break;
11332 }
11333
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000011334 if (!isAddressTaken && AI->isStaticAlloca())
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000011335 return false;
11336 }
11337
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000011338 // If this load is a load from a GEP with a constant offset from an alloca,
11339 // then we don't want to sink it. In its present form, it will be
11340 // load [constant stack offset]. Sinking it will cause us to have to
11341 // materialize the stack addresses in each predecessor in a register only to
11342 // do a shared load from register in the successor.
11343 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(L->getOperand(0)))
11344 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
11345 if (AI->isStaticAlloca() && GEP->hasAllConstantIndices())
11346 return false;
11347
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000011348 return true;
11349}
11350
Chris Lattner751a3622009-11-01 20:04:24 +000011351Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgLoadIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
11352 LoadInst *FirstLI = cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
11353
11354 // When processing loads, we need to propagate two bits of information to the
11355 // sunk load: whether it is volatile, and what its alignment is. We currently
11356 // don't sink loads when some have their alignment specified and some don't.
11357 // visitLoadInst will propagate an alignment onto the load when TD is around,
11358 // and if TD isn't around, we can't handle the mixed case.
11359 bool isVolatile = FirstLI->isVolatile();
11360 unsigned LoadAlignment = FirstLI->getAlignment();
11361
11362 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
11363 // load and the PHI.
11364 if (FirstLI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
11365 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(FirstLI))
11366 return 0;
11367
11368 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
11369 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
11370 // the path through the other successor.
11371 if (isVolatile &&
11372 FirstLI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
11373 return 0;
11374
11375 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
11376 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
11377 LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
11378 if (!LI || !LI->hasOneUse())
11379 return 0;
11380
11381 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
11382 // the load and the PHI.
11383 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
11384 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
11385 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
11386 return 0;
11387
11388 // If some of the loads have an alignment specified but not all of them,
11389 // we can't do the transformation.
11390 if ((LoadAlignment != 0) != (LI->getAlignment() != 0))
11391 return 0;
11392
Chris Lattnera664bb72009-11-01 20:07:07 +000011393 LoadAlignment = std::min(LoadAlignment, LI->getAlignment());
Chris Lattner751a3622009-11-01 20:04:24 +000011394
11395 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
11396 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
11397 // the path through the other successor.
11398 if (isVolatile &&
11399 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
11400 return 0;
11401 }
11402
11403 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
11404 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
11405 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstLI->getOperand(0)->getType(),
11406 PN.getName()+".in");
11407 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
11408
11409 Value *InVal = FirstLI->getOperand(0);
11410 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
11411
11412 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
11413 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
11414 Value *NewInVal = cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
11415 if (NewInVal != InVal)
11416 InVal = 0;
11417 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
11418 }
11419
11420 Value *PhiVal;
11421 if (InVal) {
11422 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
11423 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
11424 PhiVal = InVal;
11425 delete NewPN;
11426 } else {
11427 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
11428 PhiVal = NewPN;
11429 }
11430
11431 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
11432 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
11433 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
11434 if (isVolatile)
11435 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
11436 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
11437
11438 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile, LoadAlignment);
11439}
11440
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000011441
Chris Lattnerc22d4d12009-11-10 07:23:37 +000011442
11443/// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
11444/// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
11445/// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011446Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
11447 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
11448
Chris Lattner751a3622009-11-01 20:04:24 +000011449 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst))
11450 return FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PN);
11451 if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
11452 return FoldPHIArgLoadIntoPHI(PN);
11453
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011454 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
11455 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
11456 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
11457 // code size and simplifying code.
11458 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
11459 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattnere3c62812009-11-01 19:50:13 +000011460
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011461 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
11462 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerbf382b52009-11-08 21:20:06 +000011463
11464 // Be careful about transforming integer PHIs. We don't want to pessimize
11465 // the code by turning an i32 into an i1293.
11466 if (isa<IntegerType>(PN.getType()) && isa<IntegerType>(CastSrcTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc22d4d12009-11-10 07:23:37 +000011467 if (!ShouldChangeType(PN.getType(), CastSrcTy, TD))
Chris Lattnerbf382b52009-11-08 21:20:06 +000011468 return 0;
11469 }
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +000011470 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011471 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
11472 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011473 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000011474 if (ConstantOp == 0)
11475 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011476 } else {
11477 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
11478 }
11479
11480 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
11481 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner751a3622009-11-01 20:04:24 +000011482 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
11483 if (I == 0 || !I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011484 return 0;
11485 if (CastSrcTy) {
11486 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
11487 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
11488 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
11489 return 0;
11490 }
11491 }
11492
11493 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
11494 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011495 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
11496 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000011497 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000011498
11499 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
11500 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011501
11502 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000011503 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
11504 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
11505 if (NewInVal != InVal)
11506 InVal = 0;
11507 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
11508 }
11509
11510 Value *PhiVal;
11511 if (InVal) {
11512 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
11513 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
11514 PhiVal = InVal;
11515 delete NewPN;
11516 } else {
11517 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
11518 PhiVal = NewPN;
11519 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011520
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011521 // Insert and return the new operation.
Chris Lattnere3c62812009-11-01 19:50:13 +000011522 if (CastInst *FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011523 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattnere3c62812009-11-01 19:50:13 +000011524
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000011525 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011526 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnere3c62812009-11-01 19:50:13 +000011527
Chris Lattner751a3622009-11-01 20:04:24 +000011528 CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
11529 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
11530 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011531}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000011532
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000011533/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
11534/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000011535static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
11536 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000011537 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
11538 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
11539
11540 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000011541 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000011542 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000011543
11544 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
11545 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
11546 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000011547
11548 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
11549 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011550
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000011551 return false;
11552}
11553
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000011554/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
11555/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
11556/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
11557static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
11558 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
11559 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
11560 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
11561 return true;
11562
11563 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
11564 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
11565 return false;
11566
11567 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
11568 // the value.
11569 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
11570 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
11571 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
11572 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
11573 return false;
11574 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
11575 return false;
11576 }
11577
11578 return true;
11579}
11580
11581
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011582namespace {
11583struct PHIUsageRecord {
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011584 unsigned PHIId; // The ID # of the PHI (something determinstic to sort on)
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011585 unsigned Shift; // The amount shifted.
11586 Instruction *Inst; // The trunc instruction.
11587
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011588 PHIUsageRecord(unsigned pn, unsigned Sh, Instruction *User)
11589 : PHIId(pn), Shift(Sh), Inst(User) {}
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011590
11591 bool operator<(const PHIUsageRecord &RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011592 if (PHIId < RHS.PHIId) return true;
11593 if (PHIId > RHS.PHIId) return false;
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011594 if (Shift < RHS.Shift) return true;
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011595 if (Shift > RHS.Shift) return false;
11596 return Inst->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011597 RHS.Inst->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
11598 }
11599};
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011600
11601struct LoweredPHIRecord {
11602 PHINode *PN; // The PHI that was lowered.
11603 unsigned Shift; // The amount shifted.
11604 unsigned Width; // The width extracted.
11605
11606 LoweredPHIRecord(PHINode *pn, unsigned Sh, const Type *Ty)
11607 : PN(pn), Shift(Sh), Width(Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {}
11608
11609 // Ctor form used by DenseMap.
11610 LoweredPHIRecord(PHINode *pn, unsigned Sh)
11611 : PN(pn), Shift(Sh), Width(0) {}
11612};
11613}
11614
11615namespace llvm {
11616 template<>
11617 struct DenseMapInfo<LoweredPHIRecord> {
11618 static inline LoweredPHIRecord getEmptyKey() {
11619 return LoweredPHIRecord(0, 0);
11620 }
11621 static inline LoweredPHIRecord getTombstoneKey() {
11622 return LoweredPHIRecord(0, 1);
11623 }
11624 static unsigned getHashValue(const LoweredPHIRecord &Val) {
11625 return DenseMapInfo<PHINode*>::getHashValue(Val.PN) ^ (Val.Shift>>3) ^
11626 (Val.Width>>3);
11627 }
11628 static bool isEqual(const LoweredPHIRecord &LHS,
11629 const LoweredPHIRecord &RHS) {
11630 return LHS.PN == RHS.PN && LHS.Shift == RHS.Shift &&
11631 LHS.Width == RHS.Width;
11632 }
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011633 };
Chris Lattner4bbf4ee2009-12-15 07:26:43 +000011634 template <>
11635 struct isPodLike<LoweredPHIRecord> { static const bool value = true; };
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011636}
11637
11638
11639/// SliceUpIllegalIntegerPHI - This is an integer PHI and we know that it has an
11640/// illegal type: see if it is only used by trunc or trunc(lshr) operations. If
11641/// so, we split the PHI into the various pieces being extracted. This sort of
11642/// thing is introduced when SROA promotes an aggregate to large integer values.
11643///
11644/// TODO: The user of the trunc may be an bitcast to float/double/vector or an
11645/// inttoptr. We should produce new PHIs in the right type.
11646///
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011647Instruction *InstCombiner::SliceUpIllegalIntegerPHI(PHINode &FirstPhi) {
11648 // PHIUsers - Keep track of all of the truncated values extracted from a set
11649 // of PHIs, along with their offset. These are the things we want to rewrite.
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011650 SmallVector<PHIUsageRecord, 16> PHIUsers;
11651
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011652 // PHIs are often mutually cyclic, so we keep track of a whole set of PHI
11653 // nodes which are extracted from. PHIsToSlice is a set we use to avoid
11654 // revisiting PHIs, PHIsInspected is a ordered list of PHIs that we need to
11655 // check the uses of (to ensure they are all extracts).
11656 SmallVector<PHINode*, 8> PHIsToSlice;
11657 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 8> PHIsInspected;
11658
11659 PHIsToSlice.push_back(&FirstPhi);
11660 PHIsInspected.insert(&FirstPhi);
11661
11662 for (unsigned PHIId = 0; PHIId != PHIsToSlice.size(); ++PHIId) {
11663 PHINode *PN = PHIsToSlice[PHIId];
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011664
Chris Lattner0ebc6ce2009-12-19 07:01:15 +000011665 // Scan the input list of the PHI. If any input is an invoke, and if the
11666 // input is defined in the predecessor, then we won't be split the critical
11667 // edge which is required to insert a truncate. Because of this, we have to
11668 // bail out.
11669 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
11670 InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(PN->getIncomingValue(i));
11671 if (II == 0) continue;
11672 if (II->getParent() != PN->getIncomingBlock(i))
11673 continue;
11674
11675 // If we have a phi, and if it's directly in the predecessor, then we have
11676 // a critical edge where we need to put the truncate. Since we can't
11677 // split the edge in instcombine, we have to bail out.
11678 return 0;
11679 }
11680
11681
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011682 for (Value::use_iterator UI = PN->use_begin(), E = PN->use_end();
11683 UI != E; ++UI) {
11684 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
11685
11686 // If the user is a PHI, inspect its uses recursively.
11687 if (PHINode *UserPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(User)) {
11688 if (PHIsInspected.insert(UserPN))
11689 PHIsToSlice.push_back(UserPN);
11690 continue;
11691 }
11692
11693 // Truncates are always ok.
11694 if (isa<TruncInst>(User)) {
11695 PHIUsers.push_back(PHIUsageRecord(PHIId, 0, User));
11696 continue;
11697 }
11698
11699 // Otherwise it must be a lshr which can only be used by one trunc.
11700 if (User->getOpcode() != Instruction::LShr ||
11701 !User->hasOneUse() || !isa<TruncInst>(User->use_back()) ||
11702 !isa<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1)))
11703 return 0;
11704
11705 unsigned Shift = cast<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11706 PHIUsers.push_back(PHIUsageRecord(PHIId, Shift, User->use_back()));
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011707 }
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011708 }
11709
11710 // If we have no users, they must be all self uses, just nuke the PHI.
11711 if (PHIUsers.empty())
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FirstPhi, UndefValue::get(FirstPhi.getType()));
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011713
11714 // If this phi node is transformable, create new PHIs for all the pieces
11715 // extracted out of it. First, sort the users by their offset and size.
11716 array_pod_sort(PHIUsers.begin(), PHIUsers.end());
11717
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011718 DEBUG(errs() << "SLICING UP PHI: " << FirstPhi << '\n';
11719 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PHIsToSlice.size(); i != e; ++i)
11720 errs() << "AND USER PHI #" << i << ": " << *PHIsToSlice[i] <<'\n';
11721 );
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011722
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011723 // PredValues - This is a temporary used when rewriting PHI nodes. It is
11724 // hoisted out here to avoid construction/destruction thrashing.
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011725 DenseMap<BasicBlock*, Value*> PredValues;
11726
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011727 // ExtractedVals - Each new PHI we introduce is saved here so we don't
11728 // introduce redundant PHIs.
11729 DenseMap<LoweredPHIRecord, PHINode*> ExtractedVals;
11730
11731 for (unsigned UserI = 0, UserE = PHIUsers.size(); UserI != UserE; ++UserI) {
11732 unsigned PHIId = PHIUsers[UserI].PHIId;
11733 PHINode *PN = PHIsToSlice[PHIId];
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011734 unsigned Offset = PHIUsers[UserI].Shift;
11735 const Type *Ty = PHIUsers[UserI].Inst->getType();
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011736
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011737 PHINode *EltPHI;
11738
11739 // If we've already lowered a user like this, reuse the previously lowered
11740 // value.
11741 if ((EltPHI = ExtractedVals[LoweredPHIRecord(PN, Offset, Ty)]) == 0) {
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011742
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011743 // Otherwise, Create the new PHI node for this user.
11744 EltPHI = PHINode::Create(Ty, PN->getName()+".off"+Twine(Offset), PN);
11745 assert(EltPHI->getType() != PN->getType() &&
11746 "Truncate didn't shrink phi?");
11747
11748 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
11749 BasicBlock *Pred = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
11750 Value *&PredVal = PredValues[Pred];
11751
11752 // If we already have a value for this predecessor, reuse it.
11753 if (PredVal) {
11754 EltPHI->addIncoming(PredVal, Pred);
11755 continue;
11756 }
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011757
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011758 // Handle the PHI self-reuse case.
11759 Value *InVal = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
11760 if (InVal == PN) {
11761 PredVal = EltPHI;
11762 EltPHI->addIncoming(PredVal, Pred);
11763 continue;
Chris Lattner0ebc6ce2009-12-19 07:01:15 +000011764 }
11765
11766 if (PHINode *InPHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN)) {
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011767 // If the incoming value was a PHI, and if it was one of the PHIs we
11768 // already rewrote it, just use the lowered value.
11769 if (Value *Res = ExtractedVals[LoweredPHIRecord(InPHI, Offset, Ty)]) {
11770 PredVal = Res;
11771 EltPHI->addIncoming(PredVal, Pred);
11772 continue;
11773 }
11774 }
11775
11776 // Otherwise, do an extract in the predecessor.
11777 Builder->SetInsertPoint(Pred, Pred->getTerminator());
11778 Value *Res = InVal;
11779 if (Offset)
11780 Res = Builder->CreateLShr(Res, ConstantInt::get(InVal->getType(),
11781 Offset), "extract");
11782 Res = Builder->CreateTrunc(Res, Ty, "extract.t");
11783 PredVal = Res;
11784 EltPHI->addIncoming(Res, Pred);
11785
11786 // If the incoming value was a PHI, and if it was one of the PHIs we are
11787 // rewriting, we will ultimately delete the code we inserted. This
11788 // means we need to revisit that PHI to make sure we extract out the
11789 // needed piece.
11790 if (PHINode *OldInVal = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)))
11791 if (PHIsInspected.count(OldInVal)) {
11792 unsigned RefPHIId = std::find(PHIsToSlice.begin(),PHIsToSlice.end(),
11793 OldInVal)-PHIsToSlice.begin();
11794 PHIUsers.push_back(PHIUsageRecord(RefPHIId, Offset,
11795 cast<Instruction>(Res)));
11796 ++UserE;
11797 }
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011798 }
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011799 PredValues.clear();
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011800
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011801 DEBUG(errs() << " Made element PHI for offset " << Offset << ": "
11802 << *EltPHI << '\n');
11803 ExtractedVals[LoweredPHIRecord(PN, Offset, Ty)] = EltPHI;
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011804 }
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011805
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011806 // Replace the use of this piece with the PHI node.
11807 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*PHIUsers[UserI].Inst, EltPHI);
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011808 }
Chris Lattnerdd21a1c2009-11-09 01:38:00 +000011809
11810 // Replace all the remaining uses of the PHI nodes (self uses and the lshrs)
11811 // with undefs.
11812 Value *Undef = UndefValue::get(FirstPhi.getType());
11813 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PHIsToSlice.size(); i != e; ++i)
11814 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*PHIsToSlice[i], Undef);
11815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FirstPhi, Undef);
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011816}
11817
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000011818// PHINode simplification
11819//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011820Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000011821 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000011822 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000011823
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000011824 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
11825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
11826
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000011827 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
11828 // reducing code size.
11829 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000011830 isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1)) &&
11831 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0))->getOpcode() ==
11832 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1))->getOpcode() &&
11833 // FIXME: The hasOneUse check will fail for PHIs that use the value more
11834 // than themselves more than once.
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000011835 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
11836 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
11837 return Result;
11838
11839 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
11840 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
11841 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000011842 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
11843 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
11844 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000011845 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000011846 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
11847 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011848 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000011849 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000011850
11851 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
11852 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
11853 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
11854 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
11855 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
11856 // late.
11857 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
11858 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
11859 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000011861 }
11862 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000011863
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000011864 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
11865 // same value, for example:
11866 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
11867 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
11868 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
11869 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
11870 {
11871 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
11872 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
11873 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
11874 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
11875 ++InValNo;
11876
11877 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
11878 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
11879
11880 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
11881 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
11882 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
11883 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
11884 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
11885 break;
11886 }
11887
11888 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
11889 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
11890 // the value.
11891 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
11892 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
11893 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
11894 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
11895 }
11896 }
11897 }
Dan Gohman8e42e4b2009-10-30 22:22:22 +000011898
Dan Gohman5b097012009-10-31 14:22:52 +000011899 // If there are multiple PHIs, sort their operands so that they all list
11900 // the blocks in the same order. This will help identical PHIs be eliminated
11901 // by other passes. Other passes shouldn't depend on this for correctness
11902 // however.
11903 PHINode *FirstPN = cast<PHINode>(PN.getParent()->begin());
11904 if (&PN != FirstPN)
11905 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FirstPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
Dan Gohman8e42e4b2009-10-30 22:22:22 +000011906 BasicBlock *BBA = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
Dan Gohman5b097012009-10-31 14:22:52 +000011907 BasicBlock *BBB = FirstPN->getIncomingBlock(i);
11908 if (BBA != BBB) {
11909 Value *VA = PN.getIncomingValue(i);
11910 unsigned j = PN.getBasicBlockIndex(BBB);
11911 Value *VB = PN.getIncomingValue(j);
11912 PN.setIncomingBlock(i, BBB);
11913 PN.setIncomingValue(i, VB);
11914 PN.setIncomingBlock(j, BBA);
11915 PN.setIncomingValue(j, VA);
Chris Lattner28f3d342009-10-31 17:48:31 +000011916 // NOTE: Instcombine normally would want us to "return &PN" if we
11917 // modified any of the operands of an instruction. However, since we
11918 // aren't adding or removing uses (just rearranging them) we don't do
11919 // this in this case.
Dan Gohman5b097012009-10-31 14:22:52 +000011920 }
Dan Gohman8e42e4b2009-10-30 22:22:22 +000011921 }
11922
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011923 // If this is an integer PHI and we know that it has an illegal type, see if
11924 // it is only used by trunc or trunc(lshr) operations. If so, we split the
11925 // PHI into the various pieces being extracted. This sort of thing is
11926 // introduced when SROA promotes an aggregate to a single large integer type.
Chris Lattnerbf382b52009-11-08 21:20:06 +000011927 if (isa<IntegerType>(PN.getType()) && TD &&
Chris Lattner9956c052009-11-08 19:23:30 +000011928 !TD->isLegalInteger(PN.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))
11929 if (Instruction *Res = SliceUpIllegalIntegerPHI(PN))
11930 return Res;
11931
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000011932 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000011933}
11934
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011935Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattnerc514c1f2009-11-27 00:29:05 +000011936 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Ops(GEP.op_begin(), GEP.op_end());
11937
11938 if (Value *V = SimplifyGEPInst(&Ops[0], Ops.size(), TD))
11939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, V);
11940
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011941 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011942
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011943 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011945
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011946 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000011947 if (TD) {
11948 bool MadeChange = false;
11949 unsigned PtrSize = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
11950
11951 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
11952 for (User::op_iterator I = GEP.op_begin() + 1, E = GEP.op_end();
11953 I != E; ++I, ++GTI) {
11954 if (!isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) continue;
11955
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011956 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000011957 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need. This
11958 // explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more obvious.
11959 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>((*I)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000011960 if (OpBits == PtrSize)
11961 continue;
11962
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +000011963 *I = Builder->CreateIntCast(*I, TD->getIntPtrType(GEP.getContext()),true);
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000011964 MadeChange = true;
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011965 }
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000011966 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000011967 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011968
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011969 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
11970 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
11971 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
11972 //
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000011973 if (GEPOperator *Src = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011974 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
11975 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
11976 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
11977 //
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000011978 if (GetElementPtrInst *SrcGEP =
11979 dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src->getOperand(0)))
11980 if (SrcGEP->getNumOperands() == 2)
11981 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011982
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000011983 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011984
11985 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
11986 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011987 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*Src), E = gep_type_end(*Src);
11988 I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000011989 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011990
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011991 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011992 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000011993 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
11994 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
11995 //
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000011996 Value *Sum;
11997 Value *SO1 = Src->getOperand(Src->getNumOperands()-1);
11998 Value *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011999 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000012000 Sum = GO1;
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012001 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000012002 Sum = SO1;
12003 } else {
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000012004 // If they aren't the same type, then the input hasn't been processed
12005 // by the loop above yet (which canonicalizes sequential index types to
12006 // intptr_t). Just avoid transforming this until the input has been
12007 // normalized.
12008 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType())
12009 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012010 Sum = Builder->CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000012011 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000012012
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000012013 // Update the GEP in place if possible.
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000012014 if (Src->getNumOperands() == 2) {
12015 GEP.setOperand(0, Src->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000012016 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
12017 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000012018 }
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000012019 Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end()-1);
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000012020 Indices.push_back(Sum);
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000012021 Indices.append(GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012022 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000012023 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000012024 Src->getNumOperands() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012025 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000012026 Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end());
12027 Indices.append(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012028 }
12029
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000012030 if (!Indices.empty())
12031 return (cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() &&
12032 Src->isInBounds()) ?
12033 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
12034 Indices.end(), GEP.getName()) :
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000012035 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000012036 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000012037 }
12038
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000012039 // Handle gep(bitcast x) and gep(gep x, 0, 0, 0).
12040 if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000012041 assert(isa<PointerType>(X->getType()) && "Must be cast from pointer");
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000012042
Chris Lattner2de23192009-08-30 20:38:21 +000012043 // If the input bitcast is actually "bitcast(bitcast(x))", then we don't
12044 // want to change the gep until the bitcasts are eliminated.
12045 if (getBitCastOperand(X)) {
12046 Worklist.AddValue(PtrOp);
12047 return 0;
12048 }
12049
Chris Lattnerc514c1f2009-11-27 00:29:05 +000012050 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
12051 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
12052 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isZero();
12053
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000012054 // Transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
12055 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
12056 //
12057 // Likewise, transform: GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
12058 // into : GEP i8* X, ...
12059 //
12060 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000012061 if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000012062 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
12063 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000012064 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
12065 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType())) {
12066 // GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
12067 if (CATy->getElementType() == XTy->getElementType()) {
12068 // -> GEP i8* X, ...
12069 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000012070 return cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
12071 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
12072 GEP.getName()) :
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000012073 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
12074 GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000012075 }
12076
12077 if (const ArrayType *XATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType())){
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000012078 // GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000012079 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000012080 // -> GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000012081 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
12082 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
12083 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
12084 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
12085 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
12086 return &GEP;
12087 }
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000012088 }
12089 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000012090 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
12091 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000012092 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
12093 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000012094 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
12095 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012096 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000012097 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
12098 TD->getTypeAllocSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000012099 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012100 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000012101 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000012102 Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
12103 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012104 Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000012105 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012106 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000012107 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012108
12109 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000012110 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012111 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000012112 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012113
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012114 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::getInt8Ty(*Context)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012115 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000012116 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012117
12118 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
12119 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
12120 Value *NewIdx = 0;
12121 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
12122 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
12123 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000012124 Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(NewIdx->getType()), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012125 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000012126 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012127 Scale = CI;
12128 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
12129 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
12130 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000012131 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
12132 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000012133 Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(Inst->getType()),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000012134 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012135 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
12136 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
12137 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
12138 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
12139 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
12140 }
12141 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000012142
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012143 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000012144 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
12145 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
12146 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
Chris Lattner58b1ac72009-02-25 18:20:01 +000012147 if (ArrayEltSize && Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000012148 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000012149 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000012150 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012151 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Chris Lattner878daed2009-08-30 05:56:44 +000012152 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
12153 false /*ZExt*/);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012154 NewIdx = Builder->CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012155 }
12156
12157 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000012158 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012159 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000012160 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000012161 Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
12162 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
12163 Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000012164 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
12165 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000012166 }
12167 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000012168 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012169 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000012170
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000012171 /// See if we can simplify:
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000012172 /// X = bitcast A* to B*
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000012173 /// Y = gep X, <...constant indices...>
12174 /// into a gep of the original struct. This is important for SROA and alias
12175 /// analysis of unions. If "A" is also a bitcast, wait for A/X to be merged.
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000012176 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(PtrOp)) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012177 if (TD &&
12178 !isa<BitCastInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) && GEP.hasAllConstantIndices()) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000012179 // Determine how much the GEP moves the pointer. We are guaranteed to get
12180 // a constant back from EmitGEPOffset.
Chris Lattner092543c2009-11-04 08:05:20 +000012181 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(&GEP, *this));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000012182 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
12183
12184 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, just replace the GEP
12185 // with a bitcast of the real input to the dest type.
12186 if (Offset == 0) {
12187 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
12188 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +000012189 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) ||
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000012190 isMalloc(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000012191 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
12192 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
12193 if (I != BCI) {
12194 I->takeName(BCI);
12195 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
12196 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
12197 }
12198 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000012199 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000012200 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000012201 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000012202 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000012203
12204 // Otherwise, if the offset is non-zero, we need to find out if there is a
12205 // field at Offset in 'A's type. If so, we can pull the cast through the
12206 // GEP.
12207 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
12208 const Type *InTy =
12209 cast<PointerType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012210 if (FindElementAtOffset(InTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000012211 Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
12212 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
12213 NewIndices.end()) :
12214 Builder->CreateGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
12215 NewIndices.end());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012216
12217 if (NGEP->getType() == GEP.getType())
12218 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, NGEP);
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000012219 NGEP->takeName(&GEP);
12220 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, GEP.getType());
12221 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000012222 }
12223 }
12224
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012225 return 0;
12226}
12227
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +000012228Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocaInst(AllocaInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnere3c62812009-11-01 19:50:13 +000012229 // Convert: alloca Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: alloca [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000012230 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012231 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
12232 const Type *NewTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000012233 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Victor Hernandeza276c602009-10-17 01:18:07 +000012234 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +000012235 AllocaInst *New = Builder->CreateAlloca(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012236 New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012237
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012238 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000012239 // allocas if possible...also skip interleaved debug info
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012240 //
12241 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +000012242 while (isa<AllocaInst>(*It) || isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(*It)) ++It;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012243
12244 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
12245 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
12246 //
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012247 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000012248 Value *Idx[2];
12249 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
12250 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000012251 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
12252 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012253
12254 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
12255 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000012256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000012257 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012258 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012259 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000012260 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000012261
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012262 if (TD && isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized()) {
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000012263 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
Chris Lattner46d232d2009-03-17 17:55:15 +000012264 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate
12265 // and return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000012266 if (TD->getTypeAllocSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000012268
12269 // If the alignment is 0 (unspecified), assign it the preferred alignment.
12270 if (AI.getAlignment() == 0)
12271 AI.setAlignment(TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI.getAllocatedType()));
12272 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000012273
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012274 return 0;
12275}
12276
Victor Hernandez66284e02009-10-24 04:23:03 +000012277Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFree(Instruction &FI) {
12278 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(1);
12279
12280 // free undef -> unreachable.
12281 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
12282 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
12283 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
12284 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)), &FI);
12285 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
12286 }
12287
12288 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
12289 // when lots of inlining happens.
12290 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
12291 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
12292
Victor Hernandez046e78c2009-10-26 23:43:48 +000012293 // If we have a malloc call whose only use is a free call, delete both.
Dan Gohman7f712a12009-10-27 00:11:02 +000012294 if (isMalloc(Op)) {
Victor Hernandez66284e02009-10-24 04:23:03 +000012295 if (CallInst* CI = extractMallocCallFromBitCast(Op)) {
12296 if (Op->hasOneUse() && CI->hasOneUse()) {
12297 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
12298 EraseInstFromFunction(*CI);
12299 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
12300 }
12301 } else {
12302 // Op is a call to malloc
12303 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
12304 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
12305 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
12306 }
12307 }
Dan Gohman7f712a12009-10-27 00:11:02 +000012308 }
Victor Hernandez66284e02009-10-24 04:23:03 +000012309
12310 return 0;
12311}
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000012312
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012313/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000012314static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000012315 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000012316 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000012317 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012318 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000012319
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000012320 const PointerType *DestTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType());
12321 const Type *DestPTy = DestTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000012322 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000012323
12324 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the cast.
12325 if (DestTy->getAddressSpace() != SrcTy->getAddressSpace())
12326 return 0;
12327
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000012328 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000012329
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000012330 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012331 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000012332 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
12333 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
12334 // constants.
12335 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
12336 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
12337 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000012338 Value *Idxs[2];
Chris Lattnere00c43f2009-10-22 06:44:07 +000012339 Idxs[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
12340 Idxs[1] = Idxs[0];
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000012341 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000012342 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
12343 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
12344 }
12345
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012346 if (IC.getTargetData() &&
12347 (SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012348 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000012349 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
12350 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
12351 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012352 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
12353 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012354
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000012355 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
12356 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
12357 // the result of the loaded value.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012358 Value *NewLoad =
12359 IC.Builder->CreateLoad(CastOp, LI.isVolatile(), CI->getName());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000012360 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000012361 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000012362 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000012363 }
12364 }
12365 return 0;
12366}
12367
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000012368Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
12369 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000012370
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000012371 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012372 if (TD) {
12373 unsigned KnownAlign =
12374 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(LI.getType()));
12375 if (KnownAlign >
12376 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
12377 LI.getAlignment()))
12378 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
12379 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000012380
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000012381 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000012382 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000012383 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000012384 return Res;
12385
12386 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
12387 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000012388
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000012389 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
12390 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
12391 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
12392 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000012393 if (Value *AvailableVal = FindAvailableLoadedValue(Op, LI.getParent(), BBI,6))
12394 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, AvailableVal);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000012395
Chris Lattner878e4942009-10-22 06:25:11 +000012396 // load(gep null, ...) -> unreachable
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000012397 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
12398 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
12399 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000012400 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) && GEPI->getPointerAddressSpace() == 0){
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000012401 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
12402 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
12403 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
12404 // CFG.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012405 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012406 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012407 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000012408 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000012409 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000012410
Chris Lattner878e4942009-10-22 06:25:11 +000012411 // load null/undef -> unreachable
12412 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
12413 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op) ||
12414 (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op) && LI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0)) {
12415 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
12416 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
12417 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
12418 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
12419 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
12420 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000012421 }
Chris Lattner878e4942009-10-22 06:25:11 +000012422
12423 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_cast global) -> cast (load global)
12424 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
12425 if (CE->isCast())
12426 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
12427 return Res;
12428
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000012429 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000012430 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
12431 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
12432 // exposes redundancy in the code.
12433 //
12434 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
12435 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
12436 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
12437 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
12438 // unconditionally.
12439 //
12440 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
12441 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000012442 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
12443 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012444 Value *V1 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(1),
12445 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val");
12446 Value *V2 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(2),
12447 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val");
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000012448 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000012449 }
12450
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000012451 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
12452 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
12453 if (C->isNullValue()) {
12454 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
12455 return &LI;
12456 }
12457
12458 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
12459 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
12460 if (C->isNullValue()) {
12461 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
12462 return &LI;
12463 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000012464 }
12465 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000012466 return 0;
12467}
12468
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000012469/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012470/// when possible. This makes it generally easy to do alias analysis and/or
12471/// SROA/mem2reg of the memory object.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012472static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
12473 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
12474 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
12475
12476 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000012477 const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
12478 if (SrcTy == 0) return 0;
12479
12480 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012481
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000012482 if (!DestPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(DestPTy))
12483 return 0;
12484
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012485 /// NewGEPIndices - If SrcPTy is an aggregate type, we can emit a "noop gep"
12486 /// to its first element. This allows us to handle things like:
12487 /// store i32 xxx, (bitcast {foo*, float}* %P to i32*)
12488 /// on 32-bit hosts.
12489 SmallVector<Value*, 4> NewGEPIndices;
12490
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000012491 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
12492 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
12493 // constants.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012494 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcPTy) || isa<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
12495 // Index through pointer.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012496 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*IC.getContext()));
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012497 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
12498
12499 while (1) {
12500 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
Torok Edwin08ffee52009-01-24 17:16:04 +000012501 if (!STy->getNumElements()) /* Struct can be empty {} */
Torok Edwin629e92b2009-01-24 11:30:49 +000012502 break;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012503 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
12504 SrcPTy = STy->getElementType(0);
12505 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy)) {
12506 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
12507 SrcPTy = ATy->getElementType();
12508 } else {
12509 break;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012510 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012511 }
12512
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000012513 SrcTy = PointerType::get(SrcPTy, SrcTy->getAddressSpace());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012514 }
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000012515
12516 if (!SrcPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy))
12517 return 0;
12518
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000012519 // If the pointers point into different address spaces or if they point to
12520 // values with different sizes, we can't do the transformation.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012521 if (!IC.getTargetData() ||
12522 SrcTy->getAddressSpace() !=
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000012523 cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getAddressSpace() ||
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012524 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) !=
12525 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy))
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000012526 return 0;
12527
12528 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
12529 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
12530 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
12531 Value *NewCast;
12532 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
12533 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
12534 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
12535 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
12536 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
12537 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
12538 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
12539 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
12540 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
12541 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012542 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012543
12544 // SIOp0 is a pointer to aggregate and this is a store to the first field,
12545 // emit a GEP to index into its first field.
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000012546 if (!NewGEPIndices.empty())
12547 CastOp = IC.Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(CastOp, NewGEPIndices.begin(),
12548 NewGEPIndices.end());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000012549
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012550 NewCast = IC.Builder->CreateCast(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy,
12551 SIOp0->getName()+".c");
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000012552 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012553}
12554
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000012555/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
12556/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
12557/// value in code like this:
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000012558/// %t0 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000012559/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000012560/// %t1 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000012561/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
12562///
12563static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
12564 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
12565 if (A == B) return true;
12566
12567 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
Dan Gohman58cfa3b2009-08-25 22:11:20 +000012568 // This uses isIdenticalToWhenDefined instead of isIdenticalTo because
12569 // its only used to compare two uses within the same basic block, which
12570 // means that they'll always either have the same value or one of them
12571 // will have an undefined value.
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000012572 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
12573 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
12574 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
12575 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
12576 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
Dan Gohman58cfa3b2009-08-25 22:11:20 +000012577 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalToWhenDefined(BI))
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000012578 return true;
12579
12580 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
12581 return false;
12582}
12583
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000012584// If this instruction has two uses, one of which is a llvm.dbg.declare,
12585// return the llvm.dbg.declare.
12586DbgDeclareInst *InstCombiner::hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V) {
12587 if (!V->hasNUses(2))
12588 return 0;
12589 for (Value::use_iterator UI = V->use_begin(), E = V->use_end();
12590 UI != E; ++UI) {
12591 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI))
12592 return DI;
12593 if (isa<BitCastInst>(UI) && UI->hasOneUse()) {
12594 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI->use_begin()))
12595 return DI;
12596 }
12597 }
12598 return 0;
12599}
12600
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012601Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
12602 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
12603 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
12604
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000012605 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
12606 // alloca dead.
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000012607 // If the RHS is an alloca with a two uses, the other one being a
12608 // llvm.dbg.declare, zapify the store and the declare, making the
12609 // alloca dead. We must do this to prevent declare's from affecting
12610 // codegen.
12611 if (!SI.isVolatile()) {
12612 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
12613 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000012614 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
12615 ++NumCombined;
12616 return 0;
12617 }
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000012618 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
12619 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
12620 if (GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
12621 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
12622 ++NumCombined;
12623 return 0;
12624 }
12625 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
12626 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
12627 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
12628 ++NumCombined;
12629 return 0;
12630 }
12631 }
12632 }
12633 }
12634 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Ptr)) {
12635 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
12636 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
12637 ++NumCombined;
12638 return 0;
12639 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000012640 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012641
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000012642 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012643 if (TD) {
12644 unsigned KnownAlign =
12645 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(Val->getType()));
12646 if (KnownAlign >
12647 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
12648 SI.getAlignment()))
12649 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
12650 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000012651
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000012652 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consecutive
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000012653 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
12654 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
12655 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
12656 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
12657 --ScanInsts) {
Dale Johannesen0d6596b2009-03-04 01:20:34 +000012658 --BBI;
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000012659 // Don't count debug info directives, lest they affect codegen,
12660 // and we skip pointer-to-pointer bitcasts, which are NOPs.
12661 // It is necessary for correctness to skip those that feed into a
12662 // llvm.dbg.declare, as these are not present when debugging is off.
Dale Johannesen4ded40a2009-03-03 22:36:47 +000012663 if (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000012664 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000012665 ScanInsts++;
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000012666 continue;
12667 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000012668
12669 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
12670 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000012671 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() &&equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
12672 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000012673 ++NumDeadStore;
12674 ++BBI;
12675 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
12676 continue;
12677 }
12678 break;
12679 }
12680
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000012681 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
12682 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
12683 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
12684 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000012685 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
12686 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000012687 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
12688 ++NumCombined;
12689 return 0;
12690 }
12691 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
12692 // may not be dead.
12693 break;
12694 }
12695
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000012696 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000012697 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000012698 break;
12699 }
12700
12701
12702 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012703
12704 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000012705 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr) && SI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012706 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012707 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012708 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012709 Worklist.Add(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012710 ++NumCombined;
12711 }
12712 return 0; // Do not modify these!
12713 }
12714
12715 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
12716 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000012717 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012718 ++NumCombined;
12719 return 0;
12720 }
12721
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012722 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
12723 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000012724 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012725 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
12726 return Res;
12727 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000012728 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000012729 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
12730 return Res;
12731
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000012732
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000012733 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block (possibly
12734 // excepting debug info instructions and the pointer bitcasts that feed
12735 // into them), and if the block ends with an unconditional branch, try
12736 // to move it to the successor block.
12737 BBI = &SI;
12738 do {
12739 ++BBI;
12740 } while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
12741 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType())));
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000012742 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012743 if (BI->isUnconditional())
12744 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
12745 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000012746
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012747 return 0;
12748}
12749
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012750/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
12751/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
12752/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
12753///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012754/// Simplify things like:
12755/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
12756/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
12757///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012758bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
12759 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
12760
12761 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
12762 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
12763 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012764 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012765
12766 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
12767 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012768 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
12769 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012770 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012771 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012772 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012773 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012774 return false;
12775
12776 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012777 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012778 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012779 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012780 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012781 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012782 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000012783
12784 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
12785 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
12786 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
12787 return false;
12788
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012789 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
12790 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012791 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012792 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012793 return false;
12794
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012795 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
12796 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
12797 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
12798 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012799 --BBI;
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000012800 // Skip over debugging info.
12801 while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
12802 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
12803 if (BBI==OtherBB->begin())
12804 return false;
12805 --BBI;
12806 }
Chris Lattner7ebbabf2009-11-02 02:06:37 +000012807 // If this isn't a store, isn't a store to the same location, or if the
12808 // alignments differ, bail out.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012809 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner7ebbabf2009-11-02 02:06:37 +000012810 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1) ||
12811 OtherStore->getAlignment() != SI.getAlignment())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012812 return false;
12813 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000012814 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012815 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
12816 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
12817 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
12818 return false;
12819
12820 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000012821 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
12822 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012823 for (;; --BBI) {
12824 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
12825 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
Chris Lattner7ebbabf2009-11-02 02:06:37 +000012826 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1) ||
12827 OtherStore->getAlignment() != SI.getAlignment())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012828 return false;
12829 break;
12830 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012831 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
12832 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
12833 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012834 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
12835 return false;
12836 }
12837
12838 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012839 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
12840 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012841 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
12842 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012843 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012844 return false;
12845 }
12846 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012847
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012848 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012849 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
12850 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000012851 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012852 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
12853 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012854 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
12855 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012856 }
12857
12858 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
12859 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012860 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012861 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7ebbabf2009-11-02 02:06:37 +000012862 OtherStore->isVolatile(),
12863 SI.getAlignment()), *BBI);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012864
12865 // Nuke the old stores.
12866 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
12867 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
12868 ++NumCombined;
12869 return true;
12870}
12871
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012872
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000012873Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
12874 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000012875 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000012876 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
12877 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +000012878 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000012879 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
12880 // Swap Destinations and condition...
12881 BI.setCondition(X);
12882 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12883 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
12884 return &BI;
12885 }
12886
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012887 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
12888 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
12889 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012890 TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
12891 BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
12892 if (FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
12893 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) {
12894 FCmpInst *Cond = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
12895 Cond->setPredicate(FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred));
12896
12897 // Swap Destinations and condition.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012898 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12899 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012900 Worklist.Add(Cond);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012901 return &BI;
12902 }
12903
12904 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
12905 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
12906 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012907 TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
12908 BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
12909 if (IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
12910 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
12911 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) {
12912 ICmpInst *Cond = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
12913 Cond->setPredicate(ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred));
12914 // Swap Destinations and condition.
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000012915 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12916 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012917 Worklist.Add(Cond);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000012918 return &BI;
12919 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012920
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000012921 return 0;
12922}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012923
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012924Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
12925 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
12926 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
12927 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
12928 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
12929 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
12930 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012931 SI.setOperand(i,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000012932 ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012933 AddRHS));
12934 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012935 Worklist.Add(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012936 return &SI;
12937 }
12938 }
12939 return 0;
12940}
12941
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012942Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012943 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012944
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012945 if (!EV.hasIndices())
12946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
12947
12948 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
12949 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012951
12952 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012953 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012954
12955 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
12956 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
12957 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
12958 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
12959 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
12960 // first index
12961 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
12962 else
12963 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
12964 }
12965 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
12966 }
12967 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
12968 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
12969 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
12970 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
12971 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
12972 exti != exte && insi != inse;
12973 ++exti, ++insi) {
12974 if (*insi != *exti)
12975 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
12976 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
12977 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
12978 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
12979 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12980 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
12981 // with
12982 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
12983 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12984 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
12985 }
12986 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
12987 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
12988 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12989 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
12990 // with "i32 42"
12991 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
12992 if (exti == exte) {
12993 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
12994 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12995 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
12996 // with
12997 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
12998 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
12999 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
13000 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000013001 Value *NewEV = Builder->CreateExtractValue(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
13002 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000013003 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
13004 insi, inse);
13005 }
13006 if (insi == inse)
13007 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
13008 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
13009 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
13010 // i.e., replace
13011 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
13012 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
13013 // with
13014 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
13015 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
13016 exti, exte);
13017 }
Chris Lattner7e606e22009-11-09 07:07:56 +000013018 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Agg)) {
13019 // We're extracting from an intrinsic, see if we're the only user, which
13020 // allows us to simplify multiple result intrinsics to simpler things that
13021 // just get one value..
13022 if (II->hasOneUse()) {
13023 // Check if we're grabbing the overflow bit or the result of a 'with
13024 // overflow' intrinsic. If it's the latter we can remove the intrinsic
13025 // and replace it with a traditional binary instruction.
13026 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
13027 case Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow:
13028 case Intrinsic::sadd_with_overflow:
13029 if (*EV.idx_begin() == 0) { // Normal result.
13030 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1), *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
13031 II->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
13032 EraseInstFromFunction(*II);
13033 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHS, RHS);
13034 }
13035 break;
13036 case Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow:
13037 case Intrinsic::ssub_with_overflow:
13038 if (*EV.idx_begin() == 0) { // Normal result.
13039 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1), *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
13040 II->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
13041 EraseInstFromFunction(*II);
13042 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS);
13043 }
13044 break;
13045 case Intrinsic::umul_with_overflow:
13046 case Intrinsic::smul_with_overflow:
13047 if (*EV.idx_begin() == 0) { // Normal result.
13048 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1), *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
13049 II->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
13050 EraseInstFromFunction(*II);
13051 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS);
13052 }
13053 break;
13054 default:
13055 break;
13056 }
13057 }
13058 }
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000013059 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
13060 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
13061 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
13062 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000013063 return 0;
13064}
13065
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000013066/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
13067/// is to leave as a vector operation.
13068static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
13069 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
13070 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000013071 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000013072 if (isConstant) return true;
13073 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
13074 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
13075 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
13076 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
13077 return false;
13078 return true;
13079 }
13080 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
13081 if (!I) return false;
13082
13083 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
13084 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
13085 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
13086 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
13087 return true;
13088 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
13089 return true;
13090 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
13091 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
13092 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
13093 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
13094 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000013095 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
13096 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
13097 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
13098 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
13099 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000013100
13101 return false;
13102}
13103
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000013104/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
13105///
13106/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
13107/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013108static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
13109 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
13110 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
13111 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
13112 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
13113 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
13114
13115 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000013116 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000013117 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
13118 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013119 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
13120 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000013121 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013122 return Result;
13123}
13124
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013125/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
13126/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
13127/// extracted from the vector.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013128static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000013129 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000013130 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
13131 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000013132 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
13133 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013134 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013135
13136 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013137 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013138 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000013139 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000013140 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013141 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
13142 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
13143 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000013144 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
13145 return 0;
13146 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013147
13148 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
13149 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000013150 if (EltNo == IIElt)
13151 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013152
13153 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
13154 // vector input.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013155 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo, Context);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000013156 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000013157 unsigned LHSWidth =
13158 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013159 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000013160 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013161 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl, Context);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000013162 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013163 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth, Context);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013164 else
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013165 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013166 }
13167
13168 // Otherwise, we don't know.
13169 return 0;
13170}
13171
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000013172Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000013173 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000013174 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000013176
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000013177 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000013178 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000013179 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000013180
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000013181 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000013182 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
13183 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
13184 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000013185 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner4cb81bd2009-09-08 03:44:51 +000013186 for (unsigned i = 1; i != C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000013187 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
13188 op0 = 0;
13189 break;
13190 }
13191 if (op0)
13192 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000013193 }
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000013194
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013195 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
13196 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000013197 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000013198 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner4cb81bd2009-09-08 03:44:51 +000013199 unsigned VectorWidth = EI.getVectorOperandType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000013200
13201 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
13202 // crashing the code below.
13203 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013204 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000013205
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000013206 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
13207 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
13208 // property.
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000013209 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000013210 APInt UndefElts(VectorWidth, 0);
13211 APInt DemandedMask(VectorWidth, 1 << IndexVal);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000013212 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000013213 DemandedMask, UndefElts)) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000013214 EI.setOperand(0, V);
13215 return &EI;
13216 }
13217 }
13218
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013219 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000013221
13222 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
13223 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
13224 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
13225 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
13226 if (const VectorType *VT =
13227 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
13228 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013229 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0),
13230 IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000013231 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
13232 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000013233 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000013234
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000013235 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner275a6d62009-09-08 18:48:01 +000013236 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
13237 // profitable to do so
13238 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
13239 if (I->hasOneUse() &&
13240 CheapToScalarize(BO, isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1)))) {
13241 Value *newEI0 =
13242 Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
13243 EI.getName()+".lhs");
13244 Value *newEI1 =
13245 Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
13246 EI.getName()+".rhs");
13247 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000013248 }
Chris Lattner275a6d62009-09-08 18:48:01 +000013249 } else if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000013250 // Extracting the inserted element?
13251 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
13252 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
13253 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
13254 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000013255 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) && isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +000013256 Worklist.AddValue(EI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000013257 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
13258 return &EI;
13259 }
13260 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
13261 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
13262 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000013263 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
13264 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013265 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000013266 unsigned LHSWidth =
13267 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
13268
13269 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013270 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000013271 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
13272 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013273 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
13274 } else {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013275 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000013276 }
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +000013277 return ExtractElementInst::Create(Src,
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000013278 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), SrcIdx,
13279 false));
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000013280 }
13281 }
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +000013282 // FIXME: Canonicalize extractelement(bitcast) -> bitcast(extractelement)
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000013283 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000013284 return 0;
13285}
13286
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013287/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
13288/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
13289/// Otherwise, return false.
13290static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013291 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000013292 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013293 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
13294 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000013295 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013296
13297 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013298 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013299 return true;
13300 } else if (V == LHS) {
13301 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013302 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013303 return true;
13304 } else if (V == RHS) {
13305 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013306 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013307 return true;
13308 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
13309 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
13310 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
13311 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
13312 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
13313
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000013314 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
13315 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000013316 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000013317
13318 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
13319 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
13320 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013321 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000013322 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013323 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000013324 return true;
13325 }
13326 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
13327 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013328 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
13329 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000013330 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013331
13332 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
13333 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
13334 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
13335 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013336 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013337 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
13338 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000013339 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013340 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013341 } else {
13342 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000013343 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013344 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013345
13346 }
13347 return true;
13348 }
13349 }
13350 }
13351 }
13352 }
13353 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
13354
13355 return false;
13356}
13357
13358/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
13359/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
13360/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013361static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000013362 Value *&RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000013363 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013364 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013365 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000013366 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013367
13368 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013369 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013370 return V;
13371 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013372 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013373 return V;
13374 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
13375 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
13376 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
13377 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
13378 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
13379
13380 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
13381 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
13382 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
13383 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000013384 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
13385 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013386
13387 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
13388 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013389 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
13390 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013391 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS, Context);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000013392 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013393 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013394 return V;
13395 }
13396
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013397 if (VecOp == RHS) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013398 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask,
13399 RHS, Context);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013400 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
13401 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
13402 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013403 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013404 }
13405 return V;
13406 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013407
13408 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
13409 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013410 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask,
13411 Context))
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013412 return EI->getOperand(0);
13413
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013414 }
13415 }
13416 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013417 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013418
13419 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
13420 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013421 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013422 return V;
13423}
13424
13425Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
13426 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
13427 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
13428 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
13429
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000013430 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
13431 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
13432 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000013433
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013434 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
13435 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
13436 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
13437 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
13438 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000013439 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000013440 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
13441 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000013442 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013443
13444 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
13445 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
13446
13447 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013448 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013449
13450 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
13451 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
13452 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
13453 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
13454
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013455 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
13456 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
13457 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
13458 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013459 Value *RHS = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013460 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS, Context);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013461 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000013462 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000013463 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS,
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000013464 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013465 }
13466 }
13467 }
13468
Eli Friedmanb9a4cac2009-06-06 20:08:03 +000013469 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(VecOp->getType())->getNumElements();
13470 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
13471 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
13472 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&IE, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts))
13473 return &IE;
13474
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013475 return 0;
13476}
13477
13478
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000013479Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
13480 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
13481 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013482 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000013483
13484 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000013485
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000013486 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013487 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013488 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000013489
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000013490 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000013491
13492 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
13493 return 0;
13494
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000013495 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
13496 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
13497 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000013498 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
13499 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000013500 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000013501 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000013502
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013503 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
13504 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
13505 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
13506 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000013507 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
13508 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
13509 }
13510
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013511 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
13512 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
13513 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013514 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013515 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013516 else {
13517 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000013518 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013519 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013520 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000013521 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000013522 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000013523 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Mask[i]));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000013524 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013525 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000013526 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013527 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000013528 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000013529 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013530 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
13531 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000013532 MadeChange = true;
13533 }
13534
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013535 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013536 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000013537
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013538 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
13539 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
13540 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
13541 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
13542
13543 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
13544 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000013545 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000013546
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000013547 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
13548 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
13549 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000013550
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013551 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
13552 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
13553 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
13554 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
13555 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
13556 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
13557 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
13558 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
13559 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
13560 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
13561 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
13562 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
13563
David Greenef941d292009-11-16 21:52:23 +000013564 if (LHSMask.size() == Mask.size()) {
13565 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
13566 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
Duncan Sands76700ba2009-11-20 13:19:51 +000013567 if (Mask[i] >= e)
David Greenef941d292009-11-16 21:52:23 +000013568 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
13569 else
13570 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013571
David Greenef941d292009-11-16 21:52:23 +000013572 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this
13573 // shuffle mask, do the replacement.
13574 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
13575 unsigned LHSInNElts =
13576 cast<VectorType>(LHSSVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->
13577 getNumElements();
13578 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
13579 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
13580 if (NewMask[i] >= LHSInNElts*2) {
13581 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
13582 } else {
13583 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context),
13584 NewMask[i]));
13585 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013586 }
David Greenef941d292009-11-16 21:52:23 +000013587 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
13588 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
13589 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013590 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000013591 }
13592 }
13593 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000013594
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000013595 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
13596}
13597
13598
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000013599
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013600
13601/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
13602/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
13603/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
13604/// end of its block.
13605static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
13606 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
13607
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000013608 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Duncan Sands7af1c782009-05-06 06:49:50 +000013609 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayHaveSideEffects() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000013610 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000013611
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013612 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000013613 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
13614 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013615 return false;
13616
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000013617 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
13618 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000013619 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
13620 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000013621 Scan != E; ++Scan)
13622 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
13623 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000013624 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013625
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000013626 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013627
Dale Johannesenbd8e6502009-03-03 01:09:07 +000013628 CopyPrecedingStopPoint(I, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000013629 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013630 ++NumSunkInst;
13631 return true;
13632}
13633
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000013634
13635/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
13636/// all reachable code to the worklist.
13637///
13638/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
13639/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
13640/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
13641/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
13642/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
13643///
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000013644static bool AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000013645 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013646 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000013647 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000013648 bool MadeIRChange = false;
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000013649 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000013650 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattner67f7d542009-10-12 03:58:40 +000013651
13652 std::vector<Instruction*> InstrsForInstCombineWorklist;
13653 InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.reserve(128);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000013654
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000013655 SmallPtrSet<ConstantExpr*, 64> FoldedConstants;
13656
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000013657 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
13658 BB = Worklist.back();
13659 Worklist.pop_back();
13660
13661 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
13662 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000013663
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000013664 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
13665 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000013666
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000013667 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
13668 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
13669 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000013670 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst << '\n');
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000013671 Inst->eraseFromParent();
13672 continue;
13673 }
13674
13675 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000013676 if (!Inst->use_empty() && isa<Constant>(Inst->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner7b550cc2009-11-06 04:27:31 +000013677 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000013678 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: "
13679 << *Inst << '\n');
13680 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
13681 ++NumConstProp;
13682 Inst->eraseFromParent();
13683 continue;
13684 }
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000013685
13686
13687
13688 if (TD) {
13689 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
13690 for (User::op_iterator i = Inst->op_begin(), e = Inst->op_end();
13691 i != e; ++i) {
13692 ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i);
13693 if (CE == 0) continue;
13694
13695 // If we already folded this constant, don't try again.
13696 if (!FoldedConstants.insert(CE))
13697 continue;
13698
Chris Lattner7b550cc2009-11-06 04:27:31 +000013699 Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD);
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000013700 if (NewC && NewC != CE) {
13701 *i = NewC;
13702 MadeIRChange = true;
13703 }
13704 }
13705 }
13706
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000013707
Chris Lattner67f7d542009-10-12 03:58:40 +000013708 InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.push_back(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000013709 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000013710
13711 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
13712 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
13713 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
13714 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
13715 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
13716 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000013717 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000013718 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000013719 continue;
13720 }
13721 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
13722 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
13723 // See if this is an explicit destination.
13724 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
13725 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000013726 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000013727 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000013728 continue;
13729 }
13730
13731 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
13732 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
13733 continue;
13734 }
13735 }
13736
13737 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
13738 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000013739 }
Chris Lattner67f7d542009-10-12 03:58:40 +000013740
13741 // Once we've found all of the instructions to add to instcombine's worklist,
13742 // add them in reverse order. This way instcombine will visit from the top
13743 // of the function down. This jives well with the way that it adds all uses
13744 // of instructions to the worklist after doing a transformation, thus avoiding
13745 // some N^2 behavior in pathological cases.
13746 IC.Worklist.AddInitialGroup(&InstrsForInstCombineWorklist[0],
13747 InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.size());
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000013748
13749 return MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000013750}
13751
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013752bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000013753 MadeIRChange = false;
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013754
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000013755 DEBUG(errs() << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
13756 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013757
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000013758 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000013759 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
13760 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
13761 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000013762 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000013763 MadeIRChange |= AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000013764
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000013765 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
13766 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
13767 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
13768 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
13769 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
13770 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
13771 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
13772 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000013773
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000013774 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000013775 // A debug intrinsic shouldn't force another iteration if we weren't
13776 // going to do one without it.
13777 if (!isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(I)) {
13778 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000013779 MadeIRChange = true;
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000013780 }
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000013781
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000013782 // If I is not void type then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
13783 // This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000013784 if (!I->getType()->isVoidTy())
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000013785 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000013786 I->eraseFromParent();
13787 }
13788 }
13789 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013790
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000013791 while (!Worklist.isEmpty()) {
13792 Instruction *I = Worklist.RemoveOne();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013793 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013794
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000013795 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000013796 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000013797 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000013798 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
13799 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000013800 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013801 continue;
13802 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000013803
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000013804 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000013805 if (!I->use_empty() && isa<Constant>(I->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner7b550cc2009-11-06 04:27:31 +000013806 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000013807 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000013808
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000013809 // Add operands to the worklist.
13810 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
13811 ++NumConstProp;
13812 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
13813 MadeIRChange = true;
13814 continue;
13815 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013816
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013817 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000013818 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013819 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
Chris Lattner8db2cd12009-10-14 15:21:58 +000013820 Instruction *UserInst = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back());
13821 BasicBlock *UserParent;
13822
13823 // Get the block the use occurs in.
13824 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(UserInst))
13825 UserParent = PN->getIncomingBlock(I->use_begin().getUse());
13826 else
13827 UserParent = UserInst->getParent();
13828
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013829 if (UserParent != BB) {
13830 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
13831 // See if the user is one of our successors.
13832 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
13833 if (*SI == UserParent) {
13834 UserIsSuccessor = true;
13835 break;
13836 }
13837
13838 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
13839 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
13840 // otherwise), we can keep going.
Chris Lattner8db2cd12009-10-14 15:21:58 +000013841 if (UserIsSuccessor && UserParent->getSinglePredecessor())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013842 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000013843 MadeIRChange |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013844 }
13845 }
13846
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000013847 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it.
13848 Builder->SetInsertPoint(I->getParent(), I);
13849
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000013850#ifndef NDEBUG
13851 std::string OrigI;
13852#endif
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000013853 DEBUG(raw_string_ostream SS(OrigI); I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000013854 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Visiting: " << OrigI << '\n');
13855
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013856 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000013857 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013858 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000013859 if (Result != I) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000013860 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Old = " << *I << '\n'
13861 << " New = " << *Result << '\n');
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000013862
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013863 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
13864 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
13865
13866 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000013867 Worklist.Add(Result);
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000013868 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013869
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000013870 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
13871 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013872
13873 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
13874 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000013875 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
13876
13877 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
13878 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
13879 ++InsertPos;
13880
13881 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013882
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000013883 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000013884 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000013885#ifndef NDEBUG
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000013886 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI << '\n'
13887 << " New = " << *I << '\n');
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000013888#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000013889
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013890 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
13891 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000013892 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000013893 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013894 } else {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000013895 Worklist.Add(I);
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000013896 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013897 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000013898 }
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000013899 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013900 }
13901 }
13902
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000013903 Worklist.Zap();
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000013904 return MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000013905}
13906
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013907
13908bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000013909 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +000013910 Context = &F.getContext();
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000013911 TD = getAnalysisIfAvailable<TargetData>();
13912
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000013913
13914 /// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
13915 /// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000013916 IRBuilder<true, TargetFolder, InstCombineIRInserter>
Chris Lattnerf55eeb92009-11-06 05:59:53 +000013917 TheBuilder(F.getContext(), TargetFolder(TD),
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000013918 InstCombineIRInserter(Worklist));
13919 Builder = &TheBuilder;
13920
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013921 bool EverMadeChange = false;
13922
13923 // Iterate while there is work to do.
13924 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000013925 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013926 EverMadeChange = true;
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000013927
13928 Builder = 0;
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013929 return EverMadeChange;
13930}
13931
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000013932FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013933 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000013934}